1#ifndef __LINUX_NL80211_H
2#define __LINUX_NL80211_H
3/*
4 * 802.11 netlink interface public header
5 *
6 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
7 * Copyright 2008 Michael Wu <flamingice@sourmilk.net>
8 * Copyright 2008 Luis Carlos Cobo <luisca@cozybit.com>
9 * Copyright 2008 Michael Buesch <m@bues.ch>
10 * Copyright 2008, 2009 Luis R. Rodriguez <lrodriguez@atheros.com>
11 * Copyright 2008 Jouni Malinen <jouni.malinen@atheros.com>
12 * Copyright 2008 Colin McCabe <colin@cozybit.com>
13 * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
14 * Copyright (C) 2018-2020 Intel Corporation
15 *
16 * Permission to use, copy, modify, and/or distribute this software for any
17 * purpose with or without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above
18 * copyright notice and this permission notice appear in all copies.
19 *
20 * THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS" AND THE AUTHOR DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
21 * WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
22 * MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR
23 * ANY SPECIAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
24 * WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN
25 * ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING OUT OF
26 * OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
27 *
28 */
29
30/*
31 * This header file defines the userspace API to the wireless stack. Please
32 * be careful not to break things - i.e. don't move anything around or so
33 * unless you can demonstrate that it breaks neither API nor ABI.
34 *
35 * Additions to the API should be accompanied by actual implementations in
36 * an upstream driver, so that example implementations exist in case there
37 * are ever concerns about the precise semantics of the API or changes are
38 * needed, and to ensure that code for dead (no longer implemented) API
39 * can actually be identified and removed.
40 * Nonetheless, semantics should also be documented carefully in this file.
41 */
42
43#include <linux/types.h>
44
45#define NL80211_GENL_NAME "nl80211"
46
47#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_CONFIG		"config"
48#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_SCAN		"scan"
49#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_REG		"regulatory"
50#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_MLME		"mlme"
51#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_VENDOR		"vendor"
52#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_NAN		"nan"
53#define NL80211_MULTICAST_GROUP_TESTMODE	"testmode"
54
55#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MIN	4
56#define NL80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_MAX	15
57#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MIN	1
58#define NL80211_EDMG_CHANNELS_MAX	0x3c /* 0b00111100 */
59
60/**
61 * DOC: Station handling
62 *
63 * Stations are added per interface, but a special case exists with VLAN
64 * interfaces. When a station is bound to an AP interface, it may be moved
65 * into a VLAN identified by a VLAN interface index (%NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN).
66 * The station is still assumed to belong to the AP interface it was added
67 * to.
68 *
69 * Station handling varies per interface type and depending on the driver's
70 * capabilities.
71 *
72 * For drivers supporting TDLS with external setup (WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS
73 * and WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP), the station lifetime is as follows:
74 *  - a setup station entry is added, not yet authorized, without any rate
75 *    or capability information, this just exists to avoid race conditions
76 *  - when the TDLS setup is done, a single NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION is valid
77 *    to add rate and capability information to the station and at the same
78 *    time mark it authorized.
79 *  - %NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK is then used
80 *  - after this, the only valid operation is to remove it by tearing down
81 *    the TDLS link (%NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK)
82 *
83 * TODO: need more info for other interface types
84 */
85
86/**
87 * DOC: Frame transmission/registration support
88 *
89 * Frame transmission and registration support exists to allow userspace
90 * management entities such as wpa_supplicant react to management frames
91 * that are not being handled by the kernel. This includes, for example,
92 * certain classes of action frames that cannot be handled in the kernel
93 * for various reasons.
94 *
95 * Frame registration is done on a per-interface basis and registrations
96 * cannot be removed other than by closing the socket. It is possible to
97 * specify a registration filter to register, for example, only for a
98 * certain type of action frame. In particular with action frames, those
99 * that userspace registers for will not be returned as unhandled by the
100 * driver, so that the registered application has to take responsibility
101 * for doing that.
102 *
103 * The type of frame that can be registered for is also dependent on the
104 * driver and interface type. The frame types are advertised in wiphy
105 * attributes so applications know what to expect.
106 *
107 * NOTE: When an interface changes type while registrations are active,
108 *       these registrations are ignored until the interface type is
109 *       changed again. This means that changing the interface type can
110 *       lead to a situation that couldn't otherwise be produced, but
111 *       any such registrations will be dormant in the sense that they
112 *       will not be serviced, i.e. they will not receive any frames.
113 *
114 * Frame transmission allows userspace to send for example the required
115 * responses to action frames. It is subject to some sanity checking,
116 * but many frames can be transmitted. When a frame was transmitted, its
117 * status is indicated to the sending socket.
118 *
119 * For more technical details, see the corresponding command descriptions
120 * below.
121 */
122
123/**
124 * DOC: Virtual interface / concurrency capabilities
125 *
126 * Some devices are able to operate with virtual MACs, they can have
127 * more than one virtual interface. The capability handling for this
128 * is a bit complex though, as there may be a number of restrictions
129 * on the types of concurrency that are supported.
130 *
131 * To start with, each device supports the interface types listed in
132 * the %NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES attribute, but by listing the
133 * types there no concurrency is implied.
134 *
135 * Once concurrency is desired, more attributes must be observed:
136 * To start with, since some interface types are purely managed in
137 * software, like the AP-VLAN type in mac80211 for example, there's
138 * an additional list of these, they can be added at any time and
139 * are only restricted by some semantic restrictions (e.g. AP-VLAN
140 * cannot be added without a corresponding AP interface). This list
141 * is exported in the %NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES attribute.
142 *
143 * Further, the list of supported combinations is exported. This is
144 * in the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute. Basically,
145 * it exports a list of "groups", and at any point in time the
146 * interfaces that are currently active must fall into any one of
147 * the advertised groups. Within each group, there are restrictions
148 * on the number of interfaces of different types that are supported
149 * and also the number of different channels, along with potentially
150 * some other restrictions. See &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
151 *
152 * All together, these attributes define the concurrency of virtual
153 * interfaces that a given device supports.
154 */
155
156/**
157 * DOC: packet coalesce support
158 *
159 * In most cases, host that receives IPv4 and IPv6 multicast/broadcast
160 * packets does not do anything with these packets. Therefore the
161 * reception of these unwanted packets causes unnecessary processing
162 * and power consumption.
163 *
164 * Packet coalesce feature helps to reduce number of received interrupts
165 * to host by buffering these packets in firmware/hardware for some
166 * predefined time. Received interrupt will be generated when one of the
167 * following events occur.
168 * a) Expiration of hardware timer whose expiration time is set to maximum
169 * coalescing delay of matching coalesce rule.
170 * b) Coalescing buffer in hardware reaches it's limit.
171 * c) Packet doesn't match any of the configured coalesce rules.
172 *
173 * User needs to configure following parameters for creating a coalesce
174 * rule.
175 * a) Maximum coalescing delay
176 * b) List of packet patterns which needs to be matched
177 * c) Condition for coalescence. pattern 'match' or 'no match'
178 * Multiple such rules can be created.
179 */
180
181/**
182 * DOC: WPA/WPA2 EAPOL handshake offload
183 *
184 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK flag drivers
185 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
186 * preshared key authentication in station mode. In %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
187 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
188 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when no
189 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
190 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
191 *
192 * Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X flag can be
193 * set by drivers indicating offload support of the PTK/GTK EAPOL
194 * handshakes during 802.1X authentication in station mode. In order to
195 * use the offload the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT should have
196 * %NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS attribute flag. Drivers supporting this
197 * offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT when the attribute flag is
198 * not present.
199 *
200 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK flag drivers
201 * can indicate they support offloading EAPOL handshakes for WPA/WPA2
202 * preshared key authentication in AP mode. In %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
203 * the preshared key should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_PMK. Drivers
204 * supporting this offload may reject the %NL80211_CMD_START_AP when no
205 * preshared key material is provided, for example when that driver does
206 * not support setting the temporal keys through %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY.
207 *
208 * For 802.1X the PMK or PMK-R0 are set by providing %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
209 * using %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT support also
210 * %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME must be provided.
211 */
212
213/**
214 * DOC: FILS shared key authentication offload
215 *
216 * FILS shared key authentication offload can be advertized by drivers by
217 * setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD flag. The drivers that support
218 * FILS shared key authentication offload should be able to construct the
219 * authentication and association frames for FILS shared key authentication and
220 * eventually do a key derivation as per IEEE 802.11ai. The below additional
221 * parameters should be given to driver in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and/or in
222 * %NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS.
223 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME - used to construct keyname_nai
224 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM - used to construct keyname_nai
225 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used to construct erp message
226 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK - used to generate the rIK and rMSK
227 * rIK should be used to generate an authentication tag on the ERP message and
228 * rMSK should be used to derive a PMKSA.
229 * rIK, rMSK should be generated and keyname_nai, sequence number should be used
230 * as specified in IETF RFC 6696.
231 *
232 * When FILS shared key authentication is completed, driver needs to provide the
233 * below additional parameters to userspace, which can be either after setting
234 * up a connection or after roaming.
235 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK - used for key renewal
236 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM - used in further EAP-RP exchanges
237 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID - used to identify the PMKSA used/generated
238 *	%Nl80211_ATTR_PMK - used to update PMKSA cache in userspace
239 * The PMKSA can be maintained in userspace persistently so that it can be used
240 * later after reboots or wifi turn off/on also.
241 *
242 * %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the cache identifier advertized by a FILS
243 * capable AP supporting PMK caching. It specifies the scope within which the
244 * PMKSAs are cached in an ESS. %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and
245 * %NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA are enhanced to allow support for PMKSA caching based
246 * on FILS cache identifier. Additionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK is used with
247 * %NL80211_SET_PMKSA to specify the PMK corresponding to a PMKSA for driver to
248 * use in a FILS shared key connection with PMKSA caching.
249 */
250
251/**
252 * DOC: SAE authentication offload
253 *
254 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
255 * support offloading SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks in station
256 * mode. Similarly @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP flag can be set by
257 * drivers indicating the offload support in AP mode.
258 *
259 * The password for SAE should be specified using %NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD in
260 * %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP for station and AP mode
261 * respectively.
262 */
263
264/**
265 * DOC: VLAN offload support for setting group keys and binding STAs to VLANs
266 *
267 * By setting @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD flag drivers can indicate they
268 * support offloading VLAN functionality in a manner where the driver exposes a
269 * single netdev that uses VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs
270 * can then be added using RTM_NEWLINK/IFLA_VLAN_ID similarly to the Ethernet
271 * case. Frames received from stations that are not assigned to any VLAN are
272 * delivered on the main netdev and frames to such stations can be sent through
273 * that main netdev.
274 *
275 * %NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY (for group keys), %NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION, and
276 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION will optionally specify vlan_id using
277 * %NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID.
278 */
279
280/**
281 * DOC: TID configuration
282 *
283 * TID config support can be checked in the %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG
284 * attribute given in wiphy capabilities.
285 *
286 * The necessary configuration parameters are mentioned in
287 * &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr and it will be passed to the
288 * %NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG command in %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG.
289 *
290 * If the configuration needs to be applied for specific peer then the MAC
291 * address of the peer needs to be passed in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, otherwise the
292 * configuration will be applied for all the connected peers in the vif except
293 * any peers that have peer specific configuration for the TID by default; if
294 * the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE flag is set, peer specific values
295 * will be overwritten.
296 *
297 * All this configuration is valid only for STA's current connection
298 * i.e. the configuration will be reset to default when the STA connects back
299 * after disconnection/roaming, and this configuration will be cleared when
300 * the interface goes down.
301 */
302
303/**
304 * enum nl80211_commands - supported nl80211 commands
305 *
306 * @NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC: unspecified command to catch errors
307 *
308 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY: request information about a wiphy or dump request
309 *	to get a list of all present wiphys.
310 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY: set wiphy parameters, needs %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or
311 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX; can be used to set %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
312 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
313 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET (and the attributes determining the
314 *	channel width; this is used for setting monitor mode channel),
315 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
316 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD, and/or
317 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD.  However, for setting the channel,
318 *	see %NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL instead, the support here is for backward
319 *	compatibility only.
320 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY: Newly created wiphy, response to get request
321 *	or rename notification. Has attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and
322 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
323 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY: Wiphy deleted. Has attributes
324 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME.
325 *
326 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE: Request an interface's configuration;
327 *	either a dump request for all interfaces or a specific get with a
328 *	single %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is supported.
329 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE: Set type of a virtual interface, requires
330 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE.
331 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE: Newly created virtual interface or response
332 *	to %NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE. Has %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
333 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY and %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE attributes. Can also
334 *	be sent from userspace to request creation of a new virtual interface,
335 *	then requires attributes %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE and
336 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME.
337 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE: Virtual interface was deleted, has attributes
338 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY. Can also be sent from
339 *	userspace to request deletion of a virtual interface, then requires
340 *	attribute %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
341 *
342 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY: Get sequence counter information for a key specified
343 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX and/or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
344 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY: Set key attributes %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
345 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT, or %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_THRESHOLD.
346 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY: add a key with given %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
347 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
348 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ attributes.
349 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY: delete a key identified by %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX
350 *	or %NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
351 *
352 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON: (not used)
353 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON: change the beacon on an access point interface
354 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD and %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL
355 *	attributes. For drivers that generate the beacon and probe responses
356 *	internally, the following attributes must be provided: %NL80211_ATTR_IE,
357 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP and %NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP.
358 * @NL80211_CMD_START_AP: Start AP operation on an AP interface, parameters
359 *	are like for %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON, and additionally parameters that
360 *	do not change are used, these include %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
361 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD, %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
362 *	%NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE,
363 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP, %NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
364 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES, %NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
365 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
366 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS.
367 *	The channel to use can be set on the interface or be given using the
368 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, and the
369 *	attributes determining channel width.
370 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_START_AP
371 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP: Stop AP operation on the given interface
372 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON: old alias for %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP
373 *
374 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION: Get station attributes for station identified by
375 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
376 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION: Set station attributes for station identified by
377 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
378 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION: Add a station with given attributes to the
379 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
380 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION: Remove a station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
381 *	or, if no MAC address given, all stations, on the interface identified
382 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX. %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE and
383 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE can optionally be used to specify which type
384 *	of disconnection indication should be sent to the station
385 *	(Deauthentication or Disassociation frame and reason code for that
386 *	frame).
387 *
388 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH: Get mesh path attributes for mesh path to
389 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
390 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
391 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH:  Set mesh path attributes for mesh path to
392 * 	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
393 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
394 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH: Create a new mesh path for the destination given by
395 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC via %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP.
396 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH: Delete a mesh path to the destination given by
397 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
398 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PATH: Add a mesh path with given attributes to the
399 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
400 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PATH: Remove a mesh path identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
401 *	or, if no MAC address given, all mesh paths, on the interface identified
402 *	by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
403 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS: Set BSS attributes for BSS identified by
404 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
405 *
406 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_REG: ask the wireless core to send us its currently set
407 *	regulatory domain. If %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is specified and the device
408 *	has a private regulatory domain, it will be returned. Otherwise, the
409 *	global regdomain will be returned.
410 *	A device will have a private regulatory domain if it uses the
411 *	regulatory_hint() API. Even when a private regdomain is used the channel
412 *	information will still be mended according to further hints from
413 *	the regulatory core to help with compliance. A dump version of this API
414 *	is now available which will returns the global regdomain as well as
415 *	all private regdomains of present wiphys (for those that have it).
416 *	If a wiphy is self-managed (%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG), then
417 *	its private regdomain is the only valid one for it. The regulatory
418 *	core is not used to help with compliance in this case.
419 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REG: Set current regulatory domain. CRDA sends this command
420 *	after being queried by the kernel. CRDA replies by sending a regulatory
421 *	domain structure which consists of %NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA set to our
422 *	current alpha2 if it found a match. It also provides
423 * 	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS, and a set of regulatory rules. Each
424 * 	regulatory rule is a nested set of attributes  given by
425 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FREQ_[START|END] and
426 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW with an attached power rule given by
427 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_ANT_GAIN and
428 * 	%NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_POWER_MAX_EIRP.
429 * @NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG: ask the wireless core to set the regulatory domain
430 * 	to the specified ISO/IEC 3166-1 alpha2 country code. The core will
431 * 	store this as a valid request and then query userspace for it.
432 *
433 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG: Get mesh networking properties for the
434 *	interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
435 *
436 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG: Set mesh networking properties for the
437 *      interface identified by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX
438 *
439 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE: Set extra IEs for management frames. The
440 *	interface is identified with %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and the management
441 *	frame subtype with %NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE. The extra IE data to be
442 *	added to the end of the specified management frame is specified with
443 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IE. If the command succeeds, the requested data will be
444 *	added to all specified management frames generated by
445 *	kernel/firmware/driver.
446 *	Note: This command has been removed and it is only reserved at this
447 *	point to avoid re-using existing command number. The functionality this
448 *	command was planned for has been provided with cleaner design with the
449 *	option to specify additional IEs in NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
450 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
451 *	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE, and NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
452 *
453 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN: get scan results
454 * @NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN: trigger a new scan with the given parameters
455 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
456 *	probe requests at CCK rate or not. %NL80211_ATTR_BSSID can be used to
457 *	specify a BSSID to scan for; if not included, the wildcard BSSID will
458 *	be used.
459 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS: scan notification (as a reply to
460 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN and on the "scan" multicast group)
461 * @NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED: scan was aborted, for unspecified reasons,
462 *	partial scan results may be available
463 *
464 * @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN: start a scheduled scan at certain
465 *	intervals and certain number of cycles, as specified by
466 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS. If %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is
467 *	not specified and only %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL is specified,
468 *	scheduled scan will run in an infinite loop with the specified interval.
469 *	These attributes are mutually exculsive,
470 *	i.e. NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL must not be passed if
471 *	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS is defined.
472 *	If for some reason scheduled scan is aborted by the driver, all scan
473 *	plans are canceled (including scan plans that did not start yet).
474 *	Like with normal scans, if SSIDs (%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS)
475 *	are passed, they are used in the probe requests.  For
476 *	broadcast, a broadcast SSID must be passed (ie. an empty
477 *	string).  If no SSID is passed, no probe requests are sent and
478 *	a passive scan is performed.  %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
479 *	if passed, define which channels should be scanned; if not
480 *	passed, all channels allowed for the current regulatory domain
481 *	are used.  Extra IEs can also be passed from the userspace by
482 *	using the %NL80211_ATTR_IE attribute.  The first cycle of the
483 *	scheduled scan can be delayed by %NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY
484 *	is supplied. If the device supports multiple concurrent scheduled
485 *	scans, it will allow such when the caller provides the flag attribute
486 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI to indicate user-space support for it.
487 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN: stop a scheduled scan. Returns -ENOENT if
488 *	scheduled scan is not running. The caller may assume that as soon
489 *	as the call returns, it is safe to start a new scheduled scan again.
490 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS: indicates that there are scheduled scan
491 *	results available.
492 * @NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED: indicates that the scheduled scan has
493 *	stopped.  The driver may issue this event at any time during a
494 *	scheduled scan.  One reason for stopping the scan is if the hardware
495 *	does not support starting an association or a normal scan while running
496 *	a scheduled scan.  This event is also sent when the
497 *	%NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN command is received or when the interface
498 *	is brought down while a scheduled scan was running.
499 *
500 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY: get survey resuls, e.g. channel occupation
501 *      or noise level
502 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS: survey data notification (as a reply to
503 *	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY and on the "scan" multicast group)
504 *
505 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA: Add a PMKSA cache entry using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
506 *	(for the BSSID), %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and optionally %NL80211_ATTR_PMK
507 *	(PMK is used for PTKSA derivation in case of FILS shared key offload) or
508 *	using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID, %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
509 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PMKID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMK in case of FILS
510 *	authentication where %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID is the identifier
511 *	advertized by a FILS capable AP identifying the scope of PMKSA in an
512 *	ESS.
513 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA: Delete a PMKSA cache entry, using %NL80211_ATTR_MAC
514 *	(for the BSSID) and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID or using %NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
515 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID, and %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID in case of FILS
516 *	authentication.
517 * @NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA: Flush all PMKSA cache entries.
518 *
519 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE: indicates to userspace the regulatory domain
520 * 	has been changed and provides details of the request information
521 * 	that caused the change such as who initiated the regulatory request
522 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR), the wiphy_idx
523 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2) on which the request was made from if
524 * 	the initiator was %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE or
525 * 	%NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER, the type of regulatory domain
526 * 	set (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE), if the type of regulatory domain is
527 * 	%NL80211_REG_TYPE_COUNTRY the alpha2 to which we have moved on
528 * 	to (%NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2).
529 * @NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT: indicates to userspace that an AP beacon
530 * 	has been found while world roaming thus enabling active scan or
531 * 	any mode of operation that initiates TX (beacons) on a channel
532 * 	where we would not have been able to do either before. As an example
533 * 	if you are world roaming (regulatory domain set to world or if your
534 * 	driver is using a custom world roaming regulatory domain) and while
535 * 	doing a passive scan on the 5 GHz band you find an AP there (if not
536 * 	on a DFS channel) you will now be able to actively scan for that AP
537 * 	or use AP mode on your card on that same channel. Note that this will
538 * 	never be used for channels 1-11 on the 2 GHz band as they are always
539 * 	enabled world wide. This beacon hint is only sent if your device had
540 * 	either disabled active scanning or beaconing on a channel. We send to
541 * 	userspace the wiphy on which we removed a restriction from
542 * 	(%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY) and the channel on which this occurred
543 * 	before (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE) and after (%NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER)
544 * 	the beacon hint was processed.
545 *
546 * @NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE: authentication request and notification.
547 *	This command is used both as a command (request to authenticate) and
548 *	as an event on the "mlme" multicast group indicating completion of the
549 *	authentication process.
550 *	When used as a command, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to identify the
551 *	interface. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify PeerSTAAddress (and
552 *	BSSID in case of station mode). %NL80211_ATTR_SSID is used to specify
553 *	the SSID (mainly for association, but is included in authentication
554 *	request, too, to help BSS selection. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ +
555 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET is used to specify the frequence of the
556 *	channel in MHz. %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE is used to specify the
557 *	authentication type. %NL80211_ATTR_IE is used to define IEs
558 *	(VendorSpecificInfo, but also including RSN IE and FT IEs) to be added
559 *	to the frame.
560 *	When used as an event, this reports reception of an Authentication
561 *	frame in station and IBSS modes when the local MLME processed the
562 *	frame, i.e., it was for the local STA and was received in correct
563 *	state. This is similar to MLME-AUTHENTICATE.confirm primitive in the
564 *	MLME SAP interface (kernel providing MLME, userspace SME). The
565 *	included %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute contains the management frame
566 *	(including both the header and frame body, but not FCS). This event is
567 *	also used to indicate if the authentication attempt timed out. In that
568 *	case the %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME attribute is replaced with a
569 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT flag (and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to indicate which
570 *	pending authentication timed out).
571 * @NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE: association request and notification; like
572 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Association and Reassociation
573 *	(similar to MLME-ASSOCIATE.request, MLME-REASSOCIATE.request,
574 *	MLME-ASSOCIATE.confirm or MLME-REASSOCIATE.confirm primitives). The
575 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID attribute is used to specify whether the
576 *	request is for the initial association to an ESS (that attribute not
577 *	included) or for reassociation within the ESS (that attribute is
578 *	included).
579 * @NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE: deauthentication request and notification; like
580 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Deauthentication frames (similar to
581 *	MLME-DEAUTHENTICATION.request and MLME-DEAUTHENTICATE.indication
582 *	primitives).
583 * @NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE: disassociation request and notification; like
584 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE but for Disassociation frames (similar to
585 *	MLME-DISASSOCIATE.request and MLME-DISASSOCIATE.indication primitives).
586 *
587 * @NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE: notification of a locally detected Michael
588 *	MIC (part of TKIP) failure; sent on the "mlme" multicast group; the
589 *	event includes %NL80211_ATTR_MAC to describe the source MAC address of
590 *	the frame with invalid MIC, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE to show the key
591 *	type, %NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX to indicate the key identifier, and
592 *	%NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ to indicate the TSC value of the frame; this
593 *	event matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() primitive
594 *
595 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS: Join a new IBSS -- given at least an SSID and a
596 *	FREQ attribute (for the initial frequency if no peer can be found)
597 *	and optionally a MAC (as BSSID) and FREQ_FIXED attribute if those
598 *	should be fixed rather than automatically determined. Can only be
599 *	executed on a network interface that is UP, and fixed BSSID/FREQ
600 *	may be rejected. Another optional parameter is the beacon interval,
601 *	given in the %NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL attribute, which if not
602 *	given defaults to 100 TU (102.4ms).
603 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS: Leave the IBSS -- no special arguments, the IBSS is
604 *	determined by the network interface.
605 *
606 * @NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE: testmode command, takes a wiphy (or ifindex) attribute
607 *	to identify the device, and the TESTDATA blob attribute to pass through
608 *	to the driver.
609 *
610 * @NL80211_CMD_CONNECT: connection request and notification; this command
611 *	requests to connect to a specified network but without separating
612 *	auth and assoc steps. For this, you need to specify the SSID in a
613 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute, and can optionally specify the association
614 *	IEs in %NL80211_ATTR_IE, %NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
615 *	%NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC, %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
616 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET, %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
617 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
618 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
619 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT, and
620 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT.
621 *	If included, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ are
622 *	restrictions on BSS selection, i.e., they effectively prevent roaming
623 *	within the ESS. %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT
624 *	can be included to provide a recommendation of the initial BSS while
625 *	allowing the driver to roam to other BSSes within the ESS and also to
626 *	ignore this recommendation if the indicated BSS is not ideal. Only one
627 *	set of BSSID,frequency parameters is used (i.e., either the enforcing
628 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC,%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ or the less strict
629 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT and %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT).
630 *	Driver shall not modify the IEs specified through %NL80211_ATTR_IE if
631 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC is included. However, if %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT is
632 *	included, these IEs through %NL80211_ATTR_IE are specified by the user
633 *	space based on the best possible BSS selected. Thus, if the driver ends
634 *	up selecting a different BSS, it can modify these IEs accordingly (e.g.
635 *	userspace asks the driver to perform PMKSA caching with BSS1 and the
636 *	driver ends up selecting BSS2 with different PMKSA cache entry; RSNIE
637 *	has to get updated with the apt PMKID).
638 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID can be used to request a reassociation within
639 *	the ESS in case the device is already associated and an association with
640 *	a different BSS is desired.
641 *	Background scan period can optionally be
642 *	specified in %NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
643 *	if not specified default background scan configuration
644 *	in driver is used and if period value is 0, bg scan will be disabled.
645 *	This attribute is ignored if driver does not support roam scan.
646 *	It is also sent as an event, with the BSSID and response IEs when the
647 *	connection is established or failed to be established. This can be
648 *	determined by the %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute (0 = success,
649 *	non-zero = failure). If %NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT is included in the
650 *	event, the connection attempt failed due to not being able to initiate
651 *	authentication/association or not receiving a response from the AP.
652 *	Non-zero %NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE value is indicated in that case as
653 *	well to remain backwards compatible.
654 * @NL80211_CMD_ROAM: Notification indicating the card/driver roamed by itself.
655 *	When a security association was established on an 802.1X network using
656 *	fast transition, this event should be followed by an
657 *	%NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED event.
658 *	Following a %NL80211_CMD_ROAM event userspace can issue
659 *	%NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN in order to obtain the scan information for the
660 *	new BSS the card/driver roamed to.
661 * @NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT: drop a given connection; also used to notify
662 *	userspace that a connection was dropped by the AP or due to other
663 *	reasons, for this the %NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP and
664 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE attributes are used.
665 *
666 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS: Set a wiphy's netns. Note that all devices
667 *	associated with this wiphy must be down and will follow.
668 *
669 * @NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Request to remain awake on the specified
670 *	channel for the specified amount of time. This can be used to do
671 *	off-channel operations like transmit a Public Action frame and wait for
672 *	a response while being associated to an AP on another channel.
673 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify which interface (and thus
674 *	radio) is used. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used to specify the
675 *	frequency for the operation.
676 *	%NL80211_ATTR_DURATION is used to specify the duration in milliseconds
677 *	to remain on the channel. This command is also used as an event to
678 *	notify when the requested duration starts (it may take a while for the
679 *	driver to schedule this time due to other concurrent needs for the
680 *	radio).
681 *	When called, this operation returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
682 *	that will be included with any events pertaining to this request;
683 *	the cookie is also used to cancel the request.
684 * @NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: This command can be used to cancel a
685 *	pending remain-on-channel duration if the desired operation has been
686 *	completed prior to expiration of the originally requested duration.
687 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY or %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the
688 *	radio. The %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attribute must be given as well to
689 *	uniquely identify the request.
690 *	This command is also used as an event to notify when a requested
691 *	remain-on-channel duration has expired.
692 *
693 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK: Set the mask of rates to be used in TX
694 *	rate selection. %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is used to specify the interface
695 *	and @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES the set of allowed rates.
696 *
697 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME: Register for receiving certain mgmt frames
698 *	(via @NL80211_CMD_FRAME) for processing in userspace. This command
699 *	requires an interface index, a frame type attribute (optional for
700 *	backward compatibility reasons, if not given assumes action frames)
701 *	and a match attribute containing the first few bytes of the frame
702 *	that should match, e.g. a single byte for only a category match or
703 *	four bytes for vendor frames including the OUI. The registration
704 *	cannot be dropped, but is removed automatically when the netlink
705 *	socket is closed. Multiple registrations can be made.
706 *	The %NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST flag attribute can be given if
707 *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS is available, in which
708 *	case the registration can also be modified to include/exclude the
709 *	flag, rather than requiring unregistration to change it.
710 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME for
711 *	backward compatibility
712 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME: Management frame TX request and RX notification. This
713 *	command is used both as a request to transmit a management frame and
714 *	as an event indicating reception of a frame that was not processed in
715 *	kernel code, but is for us (i.e., which may need to be processed in a
716 *	user space application). %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
717 *	frame contents (including header). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ is used
718 *	to indicate on which channel the frame is to be transmitted or was
719 *	received. If this channel is not the current channel (remain-on-channel
720 *	or the operational channel) the device will switch to the given channel
721 *	and transmit the frame, optionally waiting for a response for the time
722 *	specified using %NL80211_ATTR_DURATION. When called, this operation
723 *	returns a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE) that will be included with the
724 *	TX status event pertaining to the TX request.
725 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE is used to decide whether to send the
726 *	management frames at CCK rate or not in 2GHz band.
727 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX is an array of offsets to CSA
728 *	counters which will be updated to the current value. This attribute
729 *	is used during CSA period.
730 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL: When an off-channel TX was requested, this
731 *	command may be used with the corresponding cookie to cancel the wait
732 *	time if it is known that it is no longer necessary.  This command is
733 *	also sent as an event whenever the driver has completed the off-channel
734 *	wait time.
735 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME for backward compatibility.
736 * @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a management frame
737 *	transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME. %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies
738 *	the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME includes the contents of the
739 *	frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included if the recipient acknowledged
740 *	the frame.
741 * @NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS: Alias for @NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS for
742 *	backward compatibility.
743 *
744 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE: Set powersave, using %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
745 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE: Get powersave status in %NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE
746 *
747 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM: Connection quality monitor configuration. This command
748 *	is used to configure connection quality monitoring notification trigger
749 *	levels.
750 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM: Connection quality monitor notification. This
751 *	command is used as an event to indicate the that a trigger level was
752 *	reached.
753 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL: Set the channel (using %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
754 *	and the attributes determining channel width) the given interface
755 *	(identifed by %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX) shall operate on.
756 *	In case multiple channels are supported by the device, the mechanism
757 *	with which it switches channels is implementation-defined.
758 *	When a monitor interface is given, it can only switch channel while
759 *	no other interfaces are operating to avoid disturbing the operation
760 *	of any other interfaces, and other interfaces will again take
761 *	precedence when they are used.
762 *
763 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER: Set the MAC address of the peer on a WDS interface
764 *	(no longer supported).
765 *
766 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST: Configure if this AP should perform
767 *	multicast to unicast conversion. When enabled, all multicast packets
768 *	with ethertype ARP, IPv4 or IPv6 (possibly within an 802.1Q header)
769 *	will be sent out to each station once with the destination (multicast)
770 *	MAC address replaced by the station's MAC address. Note that this may
771 *	break certain expectations of the receiver, e.g. the ability to drop
772 *	unicast IP packets encapsulated in multicast L2 frames, or the ability
773 *	to not send destination unreachable messages in such cases.
774 *	This can only be toggled per BSS. Configure this on an interface of
775 *	type %NL80211_IFTYPE_AP. It applies to all its VLAN interfaces
776 *	(%NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN), except for those in 4addr (WDS) mode.
777 *	If %NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED is not present with this
778 *	command, the feature is disabled.
779 *
780 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH: Join a mesh. The mesh ID must be given, and initial
781 *	mesh config parameters may be given.
782 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH: Leave the mesh network -- no special arguments, the
783 *	network is determined by the network interface.
784 *
785 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE: Unprotected deauthentication frame
786 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
787 *	deauthentication frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
788 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE: Unprotected disassociation frame
789 *	notification. This event is used to indicate that an unprotected
790 *	disassociation frame was dropped when MFP is in use.
791 *
792 * @NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE: Notification on the reception of a
793 *      beacon or probe response from a compatible mesh peer.  This is only
794 *      sent while no station information (sta_info) exists for the new peer
795 *      candidate and when @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
796 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE, or
797 *      @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM is set.  On reception of this
798 *      notification, userspace may decide to create a new station
799 *      (@NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).  To stop this notification from
800 *      reoccurring, the userspace authentication daemon may want to create the
801 *      new station with the AUTHENTICATED flag unset and maybe change it later
802 *      depending on the authentication result.
803 *
804 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN: get Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
805 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN: set Wake-on-Wireless-LAN (WoWLAN) settings.
806 *	Since wireless is more complex than wired ethernet, it supports
807 *	various triggers. These triggers can be configured through this
808 *	command with the %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute. For
809 *	more background information, see
810 *	https://wireless.wiki.kernel.org/en/users/Documentation/WoWLAN.
811 *	The @NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN command can also be used as a notification
812 *	from the driver reporting the wakeup reason. In this case, the
813 *	@NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS attribute will contain the reason
814 *	for the wakeup, if it was caused by wireless. If it is not present
815 *	in the wakeup notification, the wireless device didn't cause the
816 *	wakeup but reports that it was woken up.
817 *
818 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD: This command is used give the driver
819 *	the necessary information for supporting GTK rekey offload. This
820 *	feature is typically used during WoWLAN. The configuration data
821 *	is contained in %NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA (which is nested and
822 *	contains the data in sub-attributes). After rekeying happened,
823 *	this command may also be sent by the driver as an MLME event to
824 *	inform userspace of the new replay counter.
825 *
826 * @NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: This is used as an event to inform userspace
827 *	of PMKSA caching dandidates.
828 *
829 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER: Perform a high-level TDLS command (e.g. link setup).
830 *	In addition, this can be used as an event to request userspace to take
831 *	actions on TDLS links (set up a new link or tear down an existing one).
832 *	In such events, %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION indicates the requested
833 *	operation, %NL80211_ATTR_MAC contains the peer MAC address, and
834 *	%NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE the reason code to be used (only with
835 *	%NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN).
836 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT: Send a TDLS management frame. The
837 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION attribute determines the type of frame to be
838 *	sent. Public Action codes (802.11-2012 8.1.5.1) will be sent as
839 *	802.11 management frames, while TDLS action codes (802.11-2012
840 *	8.5.13.1) will be encapsulated and sent as data frames. The currently
841 *	supported Public Action code is %WLAN_PUB_ACTION_TDLS_DISCOVER_RES
842 *	and the currently supported TDLS actions codes are given in
843 *	&enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode.
844 *
845 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME: Used by an application controlling an AP
846 *	(or GO) interface (i.e. hostapd) to ask for unexpected frames to
847 *	implement sending deauth to stations that send unexpected class 3
848 *	frames. Also used as the event sent by the kernel when such a frame
849 *	is received.
850 *	For the event, the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC attribute carries the TA and
851 *	other attributes like the interface index are present.
852 *	If used as the command it must have an interface index and you can
853 *	only unsubscribe from the event by closing the socket. Subscription
854 *	is also for %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME events.
855 *
856 * @NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME: Sent as an event indicating that the
857 *	associated station identified by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC sent a 4addr frame
858 *	and wasn't already in a 4-addr VLAN. The event will be sent similarly
859 *	to the %NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME event, to the same listener.
860 *
861 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT: Probe an associated station on an AP interface
862 *	by sending a null data frame to it and reporting when the frame is
863 *	acknowleged. This is used to allow timing out inactive clients. Uses
864 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. The command returns a
865 *	direct reply with an %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE that is later used to match
866 *	up the event with the request. The event includes the same data and
867 *	has %NL80211_ATTR_ACK set if the frame was ACKed.
868 *
869 * @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS: Register this socket to receive beacons from
870 *	other BSSes when any interfaces are in AP mode. This helps implement
871 *	OLBC handling in hostapd. Beacons are reported in %NL80211_CMD_FRAME
872 *	messages. Note that per PHY only one application may register.
873 *
874 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP: sets a bitmap for the individual TIDs whether
875 *      No Acknowledgement Policy should be applied.
876 *
877 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY: An AP or GO may decide to switch channels
878 *	independently of the userspace SME, send this event indicating
879 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX is now on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the
880 *	attributes determining channel width.  This indication may also be
881 *	sent when a remotely-initiated switch (e.g., when a STA receives a CSA
882 *	from the remote AP) is completed;
883 *
884 * @NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY: Notify that a channel switch
885 *	has been started on an interface, regardless of the initiator
886 *	(ie. whether it was requested from a remote device or
887 *	initiated on our own).  It indicates that
888 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX will be on %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
889 *	after %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT TBTT's.  The userspace may
890 *	decide to react to this indication by requesting other
891 *	interfaces to change channel as well.
892 *
893 * @NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE: Start the given P2P Device, identified by
894 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier. It must have been created with
895 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE previously. After it has been started, the
896 *	P2P Device can be used for P2P operations, e.g. remain-on-channel and
897 *	public action frame TX.
898 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE: Stop the given P2P Device, identified by
899 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV identifier.
900 *
901 * @NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED: connection request to an AP failed; used to
902 *	notify userspace that AP has rejected the connection request from a
903 *	station, due to particular reason. %NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON
904 *	is used for this.
905 *
906 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE: Change the rate used to send multicast frames
907 *	for IBSS or MESH vif.
908 *
909 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL: sets ACL for MAC address based access control.
910 *	This is to be used with the drivers advertising the support of MAC
911 *	address based access control. List of MAC addresses is passed in
912 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS and ACL policy is passed in
913 *	%NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY. Driver will enable ACL with this list, if it
914 *	is not already done. The new list will replace any existing list. Driver
915 *	will clear its ACL when the list of MAC addresses passed is empty. This
916 *	command is used in AP/P2P GO mode. Driver has to make sure to clear its
917 *	ACL list during %NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP.
918 *
919 * @NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT: Start a Channel availability check (CAC). Once
920 *	a radar is detected or the channel availability scan (CAC) has finished
921 *	or was aborted, or a radar was detected, usermode will be notified with
922 *	this event. This command is also used to notify userspace about radars
923 *	while operating on this channel.
924 *	%NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT is used to inform about the type of the
925 *	event.
926 *
927 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: Get global nl80211 protocol features,
928 *	i.e. features for the nl80211 protocol rather than device features.
929 *	Returns the features in the %NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES bitmap.
930 *
931 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES: Pass down the most up-to-date Fast Transition
932 *	Information Element to the WLAN driver
933 *
934 * @NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT: Send a Fast transition event from the WLAN driver
935 *	to the supplicant. This will carry the target AP's MAC address along
936 *	with the relevant Information Elements. This event is used to report
937 *	received FT IEs (MDIE, FTIE, RSN IE, TIE, RICIE).
938 *
939 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START: Indicates user-space will start running
940 *	a critical protocol that needs more reliability in the connection to
941 *	complete.
942 *
943 * @NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP: Indicates the connection reliability can
944 *	return back to normal.
945 *
946 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE: Get currently supported coalesce rules.
947 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE: Configure coalesce rules or clear existing rules.
948 *
949 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Perform a channel switch by announcing the
950 *	new channel information (Channel Switch Announcement - CSA)
951 *	in the beacon for some time (as defined in the
952 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT parameter) and then change to the
953 *	new channel. Userspace provides the new channel information (using
954 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and the attributes determining channel
955 *	width). %NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX may be supplied to inform
956 *	other station that transmission must be blocked until the channel
957 *	switch is complete.
958 *
959 * @NL80211_CMD_VENDOR: Vendor-specified command/event. The command is specified
960 *	by the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID attribute and a sub-command in
961 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD. Parameter(s) can be transported in
962 *	%NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
963 *	For feature advertisement, the %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute is
964 *	used in the wiphy data as a nested attribute containing descriptions
965 *	(&struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info) of the supported vendor commands.
966 *	This may also be sent as an event with the same attributes.
967 *
968 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP: Set Interworking QoS mapping for IP DSCP values.
969 *	The QoS mapping information is included in %NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP. If
970 *	that attribute is not included, QoS mapping is disabled. Since this
971 *	QoS mapping is relevant for IP packets, it is only valid during an
972 *	association. This is cleared on disassociation and AP restart.
973 *
974 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS: Ask the kernel to add a traffic stream for the given
975 *	%NL80211_ATTR_TSID and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC with %NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO
976 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME parameters.
977 *	Note that the action frame handshake with the AP shall be handled by
978 *	userspace via the normal management RX/TX framework, this only sets
979 *	up the TX TS in the driver/device.
980 *	If the admitted time attribute is not added then the request just checks
981 *	if a subsequent setup could be successful, the intent is to use this to
982 *	avoid setting up a session with the AP when local restrictions would
983 *	make that impossible. However, the subsequent "real" setup may still
984 *	fail even if the check was successful.
985 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS: Remove an existing TS with the %NL80211_ATTR_TSID
986 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameters. It isn't necessary to call this
987 *	before removing a station entry entirely, or before disassociating
988 *	or similar, cleanup will happen in the driver/device in this case.
989 *
990 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP: Get mesh path attributes for mesh proxy path to
991 *	destination %NL80211_ATTR_MAC on the interface identified by
992 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX.
993 *
994 * @NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB: Join the OCB network. The center frequency and
995 *	bandwidth of a channel must be given.
996 * @NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB: Leave the OCB network -- no special arguments, the
997 *	network is determined by the network interface.
998 *
999 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer,
1000 *	identified by the %NL80211_ATTR_MAC parameter. A target channel is
1001 *	provided via %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes determining
1002 *	channel width/type. The target operating class is given via
1003 *	%NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS.
1004 *	The driver is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching
1005 *	operations and returning to the base channel for communication with the
1006 *	AP.
1007 * @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS
1008 *	peer given by %NL80211_ATTR_MAC. Both peers must be on the base channel
1009 *	when this command completes.
1010 *
1011 * @NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE: Similar to %NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE, but used
1012 *	as an event to indicate changes for devices with wiphy-specific regdom
1013 *	management.
1014 *
1015 * @NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN: Stop an ongoing scan. Returns -ENOENT if a scan is
1016 *	not running. The driver indicates the status of the scan through
1017 *	cfg80211_scan_done().
1018 *
1019 * @NL80211_CMD_START_NAN: Start NAN operation, identified by its
1020 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface. This interface must have been
1021 *	previously created with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE. After it
1022 *	has been started, the NAN interface will create or join a
1023 *	cluster. This command must have a valid
1024 *	%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF attribute and optional
1025 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS attributes.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is
1026 *	omitted or set to 0, it means don't-care and the device will
1027 *	decide what to use.  After this command NAN functions can be
1028 *	added.
1029 * @NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN: Stop the NAN operation, identified by
1030 *	its %NL80211_ATTR_WDEV interface.
1031 * @NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION: Add a NAN function. The function is defined
1032 *	with %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC nested attribute. When called, this
1033 *	operation returns the strictly positive and unique instance id
1034 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID) and a cookie (%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE)
1035 *	of the function upon success.
1036 *	Since instance ID's can be re-used, this cookie is the right
1037 *	way to identify the function. This will avoid races when a termination
1038 *	event is handled by the user space after it has already added a new
1039 *	function that got the same instance id from the kernel as the one
1040 *	which just terminated.
1041 *	This cookie may be used in NAN events even before the command
1042 *	returns, so userspace shouldn't process NAN events until it processes
1043 *	the response to this command.
1044 *	Look at %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER as well.
1045 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION: Delete a NAN function by cookie.
1046 *	This command is also used as a notification sent when a NAN function is
1047 *	terminated. This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC_INST_ID
1048 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE attributes.
1049 * @NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG: Change current NAN
1050 *	configuration. NAN must be operational (%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN
1051 *	was executed).  It must contain at least one of the following
1052 *	attributes: %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
1053 *	%NL80211_ATTR_BANDS.  If %NL80211_ATTR_BANDS is omitted, the
1054 *	current configuration is not changed.  If it is present but
1055 *	set to zero, the configuration is changed to don't-care
1056 *	(i.e. the device can decide what to do).
1057 * @NL80211_CMD_NAN_FUNC_MATCH: Notification sent when a match is reported.
1058 *	This will contain a %NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH nested attribute and
1059 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE.
1060 *
1061 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS: Update one or more connect parameters
1062 *	for subsequent roaming cases if the driver or firmware uses internal
1063 *	BSS selection. This command can be issued only while connected and it
1064 *	does not result in a change for the current association. Currently,
1065 *	only the %NL80211_ATTR_IE data is used and updated with this command.
1066 *
1067 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, set the PMK or PMK-R0
1068 *	for the given authenticator address (specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1069 *	When %NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME is set, %NL80211_ATTR_PMK specifies the
1070 *	PMK-R0, otherwise it specifies the PMK.
1071 * @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK: For offloaded 4-Way handshake, delete the previously
1072 *	configured PMK for the authenticator address identified by
1073 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC.
1074 * @NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED: An event that indicates an 802.1X FT roam was
1075 *	completed successfully. Drivers that support 4 way handshake offload
1076 *	should send this event after indicating 802.1X FT assocation with
1077 *	%NL80211_CMD_ROAM. If the 4 way handshake failed %NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT
1078 *	should be indicated instead.
1079 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME: Control Port (e.g. PAE) frame TX request
1080 *	and RX notification.  This command is used both as a request to transmit
1081 *	a control port frame and as a notification that a control port frame
1082 *	has been received. %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the
1083 *	frame contents.  The frame is the raw EAPoL data, without ethernet or
1084 *	802.11 headers.
1085 *	When used as an event indication %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
1086 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC are added
1087 *	indicating the protocol type of the received frame; whether the frame
1088 *	was received unencrypted and the MAC address of the peer respectively.
1089 *
1090 * @NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB: Request that the regdb firmware file is reloaded.
1091 *
1092 * @NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH: This interface is exclusively defined for host
1093 *	drivers that do not define separate commands for authentication and
1094 *	association, but rely on user space for the authentication to happen.
1095 *	This interface acts both as the event request (driver to user space)
1096 *	to trigger the authentication and command response (userspace to
1097 *	driver) to indicate the authentication status.
1098 *
1099 *	User space uses the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT command to the host driver to
1100 *	trigger a connection. The host driver selects a BSS and further uses
1101 *	this interface to offload only the authentication part to the user
1102 *	space. Authentication frames are passed between the driver and user
1103 *	space through the %NL80211_CMD_FRAME interface. Host driver proceeds
1104 *	further with the association after getting successful authentication
1105 *	status. User space indicates the authentication status through
1106 *	%NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE attribute in %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH
1107 *	command interface.
1108 *
1109 *	Host driver reports this status on an authentication failure to the
1110 *	user space through the connect result as the user space would have
1111 *	initiated the connection through the connect request.
1112 *
1113 * @NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED: An event that notify station's
1114 *	ht opmode or vht opmode changes using any of %NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
1115 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,%NL80211_ATTR_NSS attributes with its
1116 *	address(specified in %NL80211_ATTR_MAC).
1117 *
1118 * @NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, in
1119 *	the %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS attribute.
1120 *
1121 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START: start a (set of) peer measurement(s)
1122 *	with the given parameters, which are encapsulated in the nested
1123 *	%NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS attribute. Optionally, MAC address
1124 *	randomization may be enabled and configured by specifying the
1125 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MAC and %NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes.
1126 *	If a timeout is requested, use the %NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT attribute.
1127 *	A u64 cookie for further %NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE use is returned in
1128 *	the netlink extended ack message.
1129 *
1130 *	To cancel a measurement, close the socket that requested it.
1131 *
1132 *	Measurement results are reported to the socket that requested the
1133 *	measurement using @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT when they
1134 *	become available, so applications must ensure a large enough socket
1135 *	buffer size.
1136 *
1137 *	Depending on driver support it may or may not be possible to start
1138 *	multiple concurrent measurements.
1139 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT: This command number is used for the
1140 *	result notification from the driver to the requesting socket.
1141 * @NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE: Notification only, indicating that
1142 *	the measurement completed, using the measurement cookie
1143 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE).
1144 *
1145 * @NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR: Notify the kernel that a radar signal was
1146 *	detected and reported by a neighboring device on the channel
1147 *	indicated by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ and other attributes
1148 *	determining the width and type.
1149 *
1150 * @NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO: This interface allows the host driver to
1151 *	offload OWE processing to user space. This intends to support
1152 *	OWE AKM by the host drivers that implement SME but rely
1153 *	on the user space for the cryptographic/DH IE processing in AP mode.
1154 *
1155 * @NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK: The requirement for mesh link metric
1156 *	refreshing, is that from one mesh point we be able to send some data
1157 *	frames to other mesh points which are not currently selected as a
1158 *	primary traffic path, but which are only 1 hop away. The absence of
1159 *	the primary path to the chosen node makes it necessary to apply some
1160 *	form of marking on a chosen packet stream so that the packets can be
1161 *	properly steered to the selected node for testing, and not by the
1162 *	regular mesh path lookup. Further, the packets must be of type data
1163 *	so that the rate control (often embedded in firmware) is used for
1164 *	rate selection.
1165 *
1166 *	Here attribute %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is used to specify connected mesh
1167 *	peer MAC address and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME is used to specify the frame
1168 *	content. The frame is ethernet data.
1169 *
1170 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG: Data frame TID specific configuration
1171 *	is passed using %NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG attribute.
1172 *
1173 * @NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON: Unprotected or incorrectly protected Beacon
1174 *	frame. This event is used to indicate that a received Beacon frame was
1175 *	dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while beacon
1176 *	protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
1177 *
1178 * @NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS: Report TX status of a control
1179 *	port frame transmitted with %NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.
1180 *	%NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE identifies the TX command and %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
1181 *	includes the contents of the frame. %NL80211_ATTR_ACK flag is included
1182 *	if the recipient acknowledged the frame.
1183 *
1184 * @NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS: SAR power limitation configuration is
1185 *	passed using %NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC. %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY is used to
1186 *	specify the wiphy index to be applied to.
1187 *
1188 * @NL80211_CMD_MAX: highest used command number
1189 * @__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST: internal use
1190 */
1191enum nl80211_commands {
1192/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
1193	NL80211_CMD_UNSPEC,
1194
1195	NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,		/* can dump */
1196	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY,
1197	NL80211_CMD_NEW_WIPHY,
1198	NL80211_CMD_DEL_WIPHY,
1199
1200	NL80211_CMD_GET_INTERFACE,	/* can dump */
1201	NL80211_CMD_SET_INTERFACE,
1202	NL80211_CMD_NEW_INTERFACE,
1203	NL80211_CMD_DEL_INTERFACE,
1204
1205	NL80211_CMD_GET_KEY,
1206	NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY,
1207	NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY,
1208	NL80211_CMD_DEL_KEY,
1209
1210	NL80211_CMD_GET_BEACON,
1211	NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON,
1212	NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1213	NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_START_AP,
1214	NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1215	NL80211_CMD_DEL_BEACON = NL80211_CMD_STOP_AP,
1216
1217	NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION,
1218	NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION,
1219	NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION,
1220	NL80211_CMD_DEL_STATION,
1221
1222	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH,
1223	NL80211_CMD_SET_MPATH,
1224	NL80211_CMD_NEW_MPATH,
1225	NL80211_CMD_DEL_MPATH,
1226
1227	NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS,
1228
1229	NL80211_CMD_SET_REG,
1230	NL80211_CMD_REQ_SET_REG,
1231
1232	NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG,
1233	NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG,
1234
1235	NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE /* reserved; not used */,
1236
1237	NL80211_CMD_GET_REG,
1238
1239	NL80211_CMD_GET_SCAN,
1240	NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN,
1241	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SCAN_RESULTS,
1242	NL80211_CMD_SCAN_ABORTED,
1243
1244	NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE,
1245
1246	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE,
1247	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE,
1248	NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1249	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE,
1250
1251	NL80211_CMD_MICHAEL_MIC_FAILURE,
1252
1253	NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT,
1254
1255	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS,
1256	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_IBSS,
1257
1258	NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
1259
1260	NL80211_CMD_CONNECT,
1261	NL80211_CMD_ROAM,
1262	NL80211_CMD_DISCONNECT,
1263
1264	NL80211_CMD_SET_WIPHY_NETNS,
1265
1266	NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY,
1267	NL80211_CMD_NEW_SURVEY_RESULTS,
1268
1269	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA,
1270	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA,
1271	NL80211_CMD_FLUSH_PMKSA,
1272
1273	NL80211_CMD_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1274	NL80211_CMD_CANCEL_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL,
1275
1276	NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK,
1277
1278	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1279	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME,
1280	NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1281	NL80211_CMD_ACTION = NL80211_CMD_FRAME,
1282	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1283	NL80211_CMD_ACTION_TX_STATUS = NL80211_CMD_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1284
1285	NL80211_CMD_SET_POWER_SAVE,
1286	NL80211_CMD_GET_POWER_SAVE,
1287
1288	NL80211_CMD_SET_CQM,
1289	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM,
1290
1291	NL80211_CMD_SET_CHANNEL,
1292	NL80211_CMD_SET_WDS_PEER,
1293
1294	NL80211_CMD_FRAME_WAIT_CANCEL,
1295
1296	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH,
1297	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_MESH,
1298
1299	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1300	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_DISASSOCIATE,
1301
1302	NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE,
1303
1304	NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN,
1305	NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN,
1306
1307	NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN,
1308	NL80211_CMD_STOP_SCHED_SCAN,
1309	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_RESULTS,
1310	NL80211_CMD_SCHED_SCAN_STOPPED,
1311
1312	NL80211_CMD_SET_REKEY_OFFLOAD,
1313
1314	NL80211_CMD_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
1315
1316	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER,
1317	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT,
1318
1319	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_FRAME,
1320
1321	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_CLIENT,
1322
1323	NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_BEACONS,
1324
1325	NL80211_CMD_UNEXPECTED_4ADDR_FRAME,
1326
1327	NL80211_CMD_SET_NOACK_MAP,
1328
1329	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_NOTIFY,
1330
1331	NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE,
1332	NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE,
1333
1334	NL80211_CMD_CONN_FAILED,
1335
1336	NL80211_CMD_SET_MCAST_RATE,
1337
1338	NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL,
1339
1340	NL80211_CMD_RADAR_DETECT,
1341
1342	NL80211_CMD_GET_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
1343
1344	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_FT_IES,
1345	NL80211_CMD_FT_EVENT,
1346
1347	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_START,
1348	NL80211_CMD_CRIT_PROTOCOL_STOP,
1349
1350	NL80211_CMD_GET_COALESCE,
1351	NL80211_CMD_SET_COALESCE,
1352
1353	NL80211_CMD_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1354
1355	NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
1356
1357	NL80211_CMD_SET_QOS_MAP,
1358
1359	NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS,
1360	NL80211_CMD_DEL_TX_TS,
1361
1362	NL80211_CMD_GET_MPP,
1363
1364	NL80211_CMD_JOIN_OCB,
1365	NL80211_CMD_LEAVE_OCB,
1366
1367	NL80211_CMD_CH_SWITCH_STARTED_NOTIFY,
1368
1369	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1370	NL80211_CMD_TDLS_CANCEL_CHANNEL_SWITCH,
1371
1372	NL80211_CMD_WIPHY_REG_CHANGE,
1373
1374	NL80211_CMD_ABORT_SCAN,
1375
1376	NL80211_CMD_START_NAN,
1377	NL80211_CMD_STOP_NAN,
1378	NL80211_CMD_ADD_NAN_FUNCTION,
1379	NL80211_CMD_DEL_NAN_FUNCTION,
1380	NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG,
1381	NL80211_CMD_NAN_MATCH,
1382
1383	NL80211_CMD_SET_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST,
1384
1385	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_CONNECT_PARAMS,
1386
1387	NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK,
1388	NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMK,
1389
1390	NL80211_CMD_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
1391
1392	NL80211_CMD_RELOAD_REGDB,
1393
1394	NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH,
1395
1396	NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED,
1397
1398	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME,
1399
1400	NL80211_CMD_GET_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
1401
1402	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_START,
1403	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_RESULT,
1404	NL80211_CMD_PEER_MEASUREMENT_COMPLETE,
1405
1406	NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_RADAR,
1407
1408	NL80211_CMD_UPDATE_OWE_INFO,
1409
1410	NL80211_CMD_PROBE_MESH_LINK,
1411
1412	NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG,
1413
1414	NL80211_CMD_UNPROT_BEACON,
1415
1416	NL80211_CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME_TX_STATUS,
1417
1418	NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS,
1419
1420	/* add new commands above here */
1421
1422	/* used to define NL80211_CMD_MAX below */
1423	__NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST,
1424	NL80211_CMD_MAX = __NL80211_CMD_AFTER_LAST - 1
1425};
1426
1427/*
1428 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new commands by defining them
1429 * here
1430 */
1431#define NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS NL80211_CMD_SET_BSS
1432#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE
1433#define NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE NL80211_CMD_REG_CHANGE
1434#define NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE
1435#define NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1436#define NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE
1437#define NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE
1438#define NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT NL80211_CMD_REG_BEACON_HINT
1439
1440#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
1441
1442/* source-level API compatibility */
1443#define NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_GET_MESH_CONFIG
1444#define NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_CMD_SET_MESH_CONFIG
1445#define NL80211_MESH_SETUP_VENDOR_PATH_SEL_IE NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE
1446
1447/**
1448 * enum nl80211_attrs - nl80211 netlink attributes
1449 *
1450 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC: unspecified attribute to catch errors
1451 *
1452 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY: index of wiphy to operate on, cf.
1453 *	/sys/class/ieee80211/<phyname>/index
1454 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME: wiphy name (used for renaming)
1455 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS: a nested array of TX queue parameters
1456 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ: frequency of the selected channel in MHz,
1457 *	defines the channel together with the (deprecated)
1458 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE attribute or the attributes
1459 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH and if needed %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
1460 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2
1461 * @NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH: u32 attribute containing one of the values
1462 *	of &enum nl80211_chan_width, describing the channel width. See the
1463 *	documentation of the enum for more information.
1464 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1: Center frequency of the first part of the
1465 *	channel, used for anything but 20 MHz bandwidth. In S1G this is the
1466 *	operating channel center frequency.
1467 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2: Center frequency of the second part of the
1468 *	channel, used only for 80+80 MHz bandwidth
1469 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE: included with NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
1470 *	if HT20 or HT40 are to be used (i.e., HT disabled if not included):
1471 *	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT = HT not allowed (i.e., same as not including
1472 *		this attribute)
1473 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT20 = HT20 only
1474 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS = secondary channel is below the primary channel
1475 *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS = secondary channel is above the primary channel
1476 *	This attribute is now deprecated.
1477 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1478 *	less than or equal to the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1479 *	dot11ShortRetryLimit; u8
1480 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG: TX retry limit for frames whose length is
1481 *	greater than the RTS threshold; allowed range: 1..255;
1482 *	dot11ShortLongLimit; u8
1483 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD: fragmentation threshold, i.e., maximum
1484 *	length in octets for frames; allowed range: 256..8000, disable
1485 *	fragmentation with (u32)-1; dot11FragmentationThreshold; u32
1486 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD: RTS threshold (TX frames with length
1487 *	larger than or equal to this use RTS/CTS handshake); allowed range:
1488 *	0..65536, disable with (u32)-1; dot11RTSThreshold; u32
1489 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS: Coverage Class as defined by IEEE 802.11
1490 *	section 7.3.2.9; dot11CoverageClass; u8
1491 *
1492 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX: network interface index of the device to operate on
1493 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME: network interface name
1494 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE: type of virtual interface, see &enum nl80211_iftype
1495 *
1496 * @NL80211_ATTR_WDEV: wireless device identifier, used for pseudo-devices
1497 *	that don't have a netdev (u64)
1498 *
1499 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC: MAC address (various uses)
1500 *
1501 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
1502 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
1503 *	keys
1504 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
1505 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
1506 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
1507 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
1508 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
1509 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT: Flag attribute indicating the key is default key
1510 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: Flag attribute indicating the key is the
1511 *	default management key
1512 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE: For crypto settings for connect or
1513 *	other commands, indicates which pairwise cipher suites are used
1514 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP: For crypto settings for connect or
1515 *	other commands, indicates which group cipher suite is used
1516 *
1517 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval in TU
1518 * @NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing
1519 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD: portion of the beacon before the TIM IE
1520 * @NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL: portion of the beacon after the TIM IE
1521 *
1522 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID: Association ID for the station (u16)
1523 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1524 *	&enum nl80211_sta_flags (deprecated, use %NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2)
1525 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL: listen interval as defined by
1526 *	IEEE 802.11 7.3.1.6 (u16).
1527 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES: supported rates, array of supported
1528 *	rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1529 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1530 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN: interface index of VLAN interface to move station
1531 *	to, or the AP interface the station was originally added to.
1532 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO: information about a station, part of station info
1533 *	given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_STATION, nested attribute containing
1534 *	info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_info.
1535 *
1536 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS: Information about an operating bands,
1537 *	consisting of a nested array.
1538 *
1539 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID: mesh id (1-32 bytes).
1540 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION: action to perform on the mesh peer link
1541 *	(see &enum nl80211_plink_action).
1542 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP: MAC address of the next hop for a mesh path.
1543 * @NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO: information about a mesh_path, part of mesh path
1544 * 	info given for %NL80211_CMD_GET_MPATH, nested attribute described at
1545 *	&enum nl80211_mpath_info.
1546 *
1547 * @NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS: flags, nested element with NLA_FLAG attributes of
1548 *      &enum nl80211_mntr_flags.
1549 *
1550 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2: an ISO-3166-alpha2 country code for which the
1551 * 	current regulatory domain should be set to or is already set to.
1552 * 	For example, 'CR', for Costa Rica. This attribute is used by the kernel
1553 * 	to query the CRDA to retrieve one regulatory domain. This attribute can
1554 * 	also be used by userspace to query the kernel for the currently set
1555 * 	regulatory domain. We chose an alpha2 as that is also used by the
1556 * 	IEEE-802.11 country information element to identify a country.
1557 * 	Users can also simply ask the wireless core to set regulatory domain
1558 * 	to a specific alpha2.
1559 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES: a nested array of regulatory domain regulatory
1560 *	rules.
1561 *
1562 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (u8, 0 or 1)
1563 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1564 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1565 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time enabled
1566 *	(u8, 0 or 1)
1567 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES: basic rates, array of basic
1568 *	rates in format defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but without the length
1569 *	restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1570 *
1571 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY: HT Capability information element (from
1572 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
1573 *
1574 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing all
1575 *	supported interface types, each a flag attribute with the number
1576 *	of the interface mode.
1577 *
1578 * @NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE: Management frame subtype for
1579 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE.
1580 *
1581 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE: Information element(s) data (used, e.g., with
1582 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_MGMT_EXTRA_IE).
1583 *
1584 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can scan with
1585 *	a single scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1586 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS: number of SSIDs you can
1587 *	scan with a single scheduled scan request, a wiphy attribute.
1588 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information elements
1589 *	that can be added to a scan request
1590 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN: maximum length of information
1591 *	elements that can be added to a scheduled scan request
1592 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS: maximum number of sets that can be
1593 *	used with @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH, a wiphy attribute.
1594 *
1595 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES: nested attribute with frequencies (in MHz)
1596 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS: nested attribute with SSIDs, leave out for passive
1597 *	scanning and include a zero-length SSID (wildcard) for wildcard scan
1598 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS: scan result BSS
1599 *
1600 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR: indicates who requested the regulatory domain
1601 * 	currently in effect. This could be any of the %NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_*
1602 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE: indicates the type of the regulatory domain currently
1603 * 	set. This can be one of the nl80211_reg_type (%NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_*)
1604 *
1605 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS: wiphy attribute that specifies
1606 *	an array of command numbers (i.e. a mapping index to command number)
1607 *	that the driver for the given wiphy supports.
1608 *
1609 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME: frame data (binary attribute), including frame header
1610 *	and body, but not FCS; used, e.g., with NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE and
1611 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE events
1612 * @NL80211_ATTR_SSID: SSID (binary attribute, 0..32 octets)
1613 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE: AuthenticationType, see &enum nl80211_auth_type,
1614 *	represented as a u32
1615 * @NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE: ReasonCode for %NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE and
1616 *	%NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE, u16
1617 *
1618 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE: Key Type, see &enum nl80211_key_type, represented as
1619 *	a u32
1620 *
1621 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1622 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1623 * 	the state of the channel _before_ the beacon hint processing. This
1624 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1625 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1626 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER: A channel which has suffered a regulatory change
1627 * 	due to considerations from a beacon hint. This attribute reflects
1628 * 	the state of the channel _after_ the beacon hint processing. This
1629 * 	attributes consists of a nested attribute containing
1630 * 	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_*
1631 *
1632 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES: a set of u32 values indicating the supported
1633 *	cipher suites
1634 *
1635 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED: a flag indicating the IBSS should not try to look
1636 *	for other networks on different channels
1637 *
1638 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT: a flag indicating than an operation timed out; this
1639 *	is used, e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE event
1640 *
1641 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP: Whether management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) is
1642 *	used for the association (&enum nl80211_mfp, represented as a u32);
1643 *	this attribute can be used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
1644 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests. %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL is not allowed for
1645 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE since user space SME is expected and hence, it
1646 *	must have decided whether to use management frame protection or not.
1647 *	Setting %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL with a %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT request will
1648 *	let the driver (or the firmware) decide whether to use MFP or not.
1649 *
1650 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2: Attribute containing a
1651 *	&struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
1652 *
1653 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT: A flag indicating whether user space controls
1654 *	IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED, in
1655 *	station mode. If the flag is included in %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE
1656 *	request, the driver will assume that the port is unauthorized until
1657 *	authorized by user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by
1658 *	default in station mode.
1659 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE: A 16-bit value indicating the
1660 *	ethertype that will be used for key negotiation. It can be
1661 *	specified with the associate and connect commands. If it is not
1662 *	specified, the value defaults to 0x888E (PAE, 802.1X). This
1663 *	attribute is also used as a flag in the wiphy information to
1664 *	indicate that protocols other than PAE are supported.
1665 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT: When included along with
1666 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE, indicates that the custom
1667 *	ethertype frames used for key negotiation must not be encrypted.
1668 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: A flag indicating whether control
1669 *	port frames (e.g. of type given in %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE)
1670 *	will be sent directly to the network interface or sent via the NL80211
1671 *	socket.  If this attribute is missing, then legacy behavior of sending
1672 *	control port frames directly to the network interface is used.  If the
1673 *	flag is included, then control port frames are sent over NL80211 instead
1674 *	using %CMD_CONTROL_PORT_FRAME.  If control port routing over NL80211 is
1675 *	to be used then userspace must also use the %NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
1676 *	flag. When used with %NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH, pre-auth
1677 *	frames are not forwared over the control port.
1678 *
1679 * @NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA: Testmode data blob, passed through to the driver.
1680 *	We recommend using nested, driver-specific attributes within this.
1681 *
1682 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP: A flag indicating that the DISCONNECT
1683 *	event was due to the AP disconnecting the station, and not due to
1684 *	a local disconnect request.
1685 * @NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE: StatusCode for the %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
1686 *	event (u16)
1687 * @NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY: Flag attribute, used with connect(), indicating
1688 *	that protected APs should be used. This is also used with NEW_BEACON to
1689 *	indicate that the BSS is to use protection.
1690 *
1691 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHERS_PAIRWISE: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON
1692 *	to indicate which unicast key ciphers will be used with the connection
1693 *	(an array of u32).
1694 * @NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_GROUP: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1695 *	indicate which group key cipher will be used with the connection (a
1696 *	u32).
1697 * @NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1698 *	indicate which WPA version(s) the AP we want to associate with is using
1699 *	(a u32 with flags from &enum nl80211_wpa_versions).
1700 * @NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES: Used with CONNECT, ASSOCIATE, and NEW_BEACON to
1701 *	indicate which key management algorithm(s) to use (an array of u32).
1702 *	This attribute is also sent in response to @NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY,
1703 *	indicating the supported AKM suites, intended for specific drivers which
1704 *	implement SME and have constraints on which AKMs are supported and also
1705 *	the cases where an AKM support is offloaded to the driver/firmware.
1706 *	If there is no such notification from the driver, user space should
1707 *	assume the driver supports all the AKM suites.
1708 *
1709 * @NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE: (Re)association request information elements as
1710 *	sent out by the card, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1711 * @NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE: (Re)association response information elements as
1712 *	sent by peer, for ROAM and successful CONNECT events.
1713 *
1714 * @NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID: previous BSSID, to be used in ASSOCIATE and CONNECT
1715 *	commands to specify a request to reassociate within an ESS, i.e., to use
1716 *	Reassociate Request frame (with the value of this attribute in the
1717 *	Current AP address field) instead of Association Request frame which is
1718 *	used for the initial association to an ESS.
1719 *
1720 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY: key information in a nested attribute with
1721 *	%NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1722 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEYS: array of keys for static WEP keys for connect()
1723 *	and join_ibss(), key information is in a nested attribute each
1724 *	with %NL80211_KEY_* sub-attributes
1725 *
1726 * @NL80211_ATTR_PID: Process ID of a network namespace.
1727 *
1728 * @NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION: Used to indicate consistent snapshots for
1729 *	dumps. This number increases whenever the object list being
1730 *	dumped changes, and as such userspace can verify that it has
1731 *	obtained a complete and consistent snapshot by verifying that
1732 *	all dump messages contain the same generation number. If it
1733 *	changed then the list changed and the dump should be repeated
1734 *	completely from scratch.
1735 *
1736 * @NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR: Use 4-address frames on a virtual interface
1737 *
1738 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO: survey information about a channel, part of
1739 *      the survey response for %NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY, nested attribute
1740 *      containing info as possible, see &enum survey_info.
1741 *
1742 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKID: PMK material for PMKSA caching.
1743 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS: maximum number of PMKIDs a firmware can
1744 *	cache, a wiphy attribute.
1745 *
1746 * @NL80211_ATTR_DURATION: Duration of an operation in milliseconds, u32.
1747 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION: Device attribute that
1748 *	specifies the maximum duration that can be requested with the
1749 *	remain-on-channel operation, in milliseconds, u32.
1750 *
1751 * @NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE: Generic 64-bit cookie to identify objects.
1752 *
1753 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES: Nested set of attributes
1754 *	(enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes) describing TX rates per band. The
1755 *	enum nl80211_band value is used as the index (nla_type() of the nested
1756 *	data. If a band is not included, it will be configured to allow all
1757 *	rates based on negotiated supported rates information. This attribute
1758 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_TX_BITRATE_MASK and with starting AP,
1759 *	and joining mesh networks (not IBSS yet). In the later case, it must
1760 *	specify just a single bitrate, which is to be used for the beacon.
1761 *	The driver must also specify support for this with the extended
1762 *	features NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
1763 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
1764 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT and
1765 *	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE.
1766 *
1767 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH: A binary attribute which typically must contain
1768 *	at least one byte, currently used with @NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME.
1769 * @NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE: A u16 indicating the frame type/subtype for the
1770 *	@NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command.
1771 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1772 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1773 *	information about which frame types can be transmitted with
1774 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
1775 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES: wiphy capability attribute, which is a
1776 *	nested attribute of %NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE attributes, containing
1777 *	information about which frame types can be registered for RX.
1778 *
1779 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACK: Flag attribute indicating that the frame was
1780 *	acknowledged by the recipient.
1781 *
1782 * @NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE: powersave state, using &enum nl80211_ps_state values.
1783 *
1784 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM: connection quality monitor configuration in a
1785 *	nested attribute with %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_* sub-attributes.
1786 *
1787 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE: Flag attribute to indicate that a command
1788 *	is requesting a local authentication/association state change without
1789 *	invoking actual management frame exchange. This can be used with
1790 *	NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE, NL80211_CMD_DEAUTHENTICATE,
1791 *	NL80211_CMD_DISASSOCIATE.
1792 *
1793 * @NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE: (AP mode) Do not forward traffic between stations
1794 *	connected to this BSS.
1795 *
1796 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type. See
1797 *      &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for possible values.
1798 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL: Transmit power level in signed mBm units.
1799 *      This is used in association with @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING
1800 *      for non-automatic settings.
1801 *
1802 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN, which mostly
1803 *	means support for per-station GTKs.
1804 *
1805 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for transmitting.
1806 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1807 *	not be used for transmitting. If an antenna is not selected in this
1808 *	bitmap the hardware is not allowed to transmit on this antenna.
1809 *
1810 *	Each bit represents one antenna, starting with antenna 1 at the first
1811 *	bit. Depending on which antennas are selected in the bitmap, 802.11n
1812 *	drivers can derive which chainmasks to use (if all antennas belonging to
1813 *	a particular chain are disabled this chain should be disabled) and if
1814 *	a chain has diversity antennas wether diversity should be used or not.
1815 *	HT capabilities (STBC, TX Beamforming, Antenna selection) can be
1816 *	derived from the available chains after applying the antenna mask.
1817 *	Non-802.11n drivers can derive wether to use diversity or not.
1818 *	Drivers may reject configurations or RX/TX mask combinations they cannot
1819 *	support by returning -EINVAL.
1820 *
1821 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX: Bitmap of allowed antennas for receiving.
1822 *	This can be used to mask out antennas which are not attached or should
1823 *	not be used for receiving. If an antenna is not selected in this bitmap
1824 *	the hardware should not be configured to receive on this antenna.
1825 *	For a more detailed description see @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX.
1826 *
1827 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1828 *	for configuration as TX antennas via the above parameters.
1829 *
1830 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX: Bitmap of antennas which are available
1831 *	for configuration as RX antennas via the above parameters.
1832 *
1833 * @NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE: Multicast tx rate (in 100 kbps) for IBSS
1834 *
1835 * @NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK: For management frame TX, the frame may be
1836 *	transmitted on another channel when the channel given doesn't match
1837 *	the current channel. If the current channel doesn't match and this
1838 *	flag isn't set, the frame will be rejected. This is also used as an
1839 *	nl80211 capability flag.
1840 *
1841 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE: HT operation mode (u16)
1842 *
1843 * @NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
1844 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
1845 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
1846 *
1847 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP: Optional mesh setup parameters.  These cannot be
1848 *	changed once the mesh is active.
1849 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG: Mesh configuration parameters, a nested attribute
1850 *	containing attributes from &enum nl80211_meshconf_params.
1851 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH: Currently, this means the underlying driver
1852 *	allows auth frames in a mesh to be passed to userspace for processing via
1853 *	the @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH flag.
1854 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE: The state of a mesh peer link as defined in
1855 *	&enum nl80211_plink_state. Used when userspace is driving the peer link
1856 *	management state machine.  @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE or
1857 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM must be enabled.
1858 *
1859 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED: indicates, as part of the wiphy
1860 *	capabilities, the supported WoWLAN triggers
1861 * @NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS: used by %NL80211_CMD_SET_WOWLAN to
1862 *	indicate which WoW triggers should be enabled. This is also
1863 *	used by %NL80211_CMD_GET_WOWLAN to get the currently enabled WoWLAN
1864 *	triggers.
1865 *
1866 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL: Interval between scheduled scan
1867 *	cycles, in msecs.
1868 *
1869 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH: Nested attribute with one or more
1870 *	sets of attributes to match during scheduled scans.  Only BSSs
1871 *	that match any of the sets will be reported.  These are
1872 *	pass-thru filter rules.
1873 *	For a match to succeed, the BSS must match all attributes of a
1874 *	set.  Since not every hardware supports matching all types of
1875 *	attributes, there is no guarantee that the reported BSSs are
1876 *	fully complying with the match sets and userspace needs to be
1877 *	able to ignore them by itself.
1878 *	Thus, the implementation is somewhat hardware-dependent, but
1879 *	this is only an optimization and the userspace application
1880 *	needs to handle all the non-filtered results anyway.
1881 *	If the match attributes don't make sense when combined with
1882 *	the values passed in @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS (eg. if an SSID
1883 *	is included in the probe request, but the match attributes
1884 *	will never let it go through), -EINVAL may be returned.
1885 *	If omitted, no filtering is done.
1886 *
1887 * @NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS: Nested attribute listing the supported
1888 *	interface combinations. In each nested item, it contains attributes
1889 *	defined in &enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs.
1890 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES: Nested attribute (just like
1891 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES) containing the interface types that
1892 *	are managed in software: interfaces of these types aren't subject to
1893 *	any restrictions in their number or combinations.
1894 *
1895 * @NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA: nested attribute containing the information
1896 *	necessary for GTK rekeying in the device, see &enum nl80211_rekey_data.
1897 *
1898 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES: rates per to be advertised as supported in scan,
1899 *	nested array attribute containing an entry for each band, with the entry
1900 *	being a list of supported rates as defined by IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 but
1901 *	without the length restriction (at most %NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES).
1902 *
1903 * @NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID: indicates whether SSID is to be hidden from Beacon
1904 *	and Probe Response (when response to wildcard Probe Request); see
1905 *	&enum nl80211_hidden_ssid, represented as a u32
1906 *
1907 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP: Information element(s) for Probe Response frame.
1908 *	This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to
1909 *	provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into Probe Response frames when the
1910 *	driver (or firmware) replies to Probe Request frames.
1911 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP: Information element(s) for (Re)Association
1912 *	Response frames. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_NEW_BEACON and
1913 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON to provide extra IEs (e.g., WPS/P2P IE) into
1914 *	(Re)Association Response frames when the driver (or firmware) replies to
1915 *	(Re)Association Request frames.
1916 *
1917 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME: Nested attribute containing the wme configuration
1918 *	of the station, see &enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr.
1919 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD: the device supports uapsd when working
1920 *	as AP.
1921 *
1922 * @NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT: Indicates whether the firmware is capable of
1923 *	roaming to another AP in the same ESS if the signal lever is low.
1924 *
1925 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: Nested attribute containing the PMKSA caching
1926 *	candidate information, see &enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr.
1927 *
1928 * @NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE: Indicates whether to use CCK rate or not
1929 *	for management frames transmission. In order to avoid p2p probe/action
1930 *	frames are being transmitted at CCK rate in 2GHz band, the user space
1931 *	applications use this attribute.
1932 *	This attribute is used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and
1933 *	%NL80211_CMD_FRAME commands.
1934 *
1935 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION: Low level TDLS action code (e.g. link setup
1936 *	request, link setup confirm, link teardown, etc.). Values are
1937 *	described in the TDLS (802.11z) specification.
1938 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN: Non-zero token for uniquely identifying a
1939 *	TDLS conversation between two devices.
1940 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION: High level TDLS operation; see
1941 *	&enum nl80211_tdls_operation, represented as a u8.
1942 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT: A flag indicating the device can operate
1943 *	as a TDLS peer sta.
1944 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The TDLS discovery/setup and teardown
1945 *	procedures should be performed by sending TDLS packets via
1946 *	%NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT. Otherwise %NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
1947 *	used for asking the driver to perform a TDLS operation.
1948 *
1949 * @NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME: This u32 attribute may be listed for devices
1950 *	that have AP support to indicate that they have the AP SME integrated
1951 *	with support for the features listed in this attribute, see
1952 *	&enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
1953 *
1954 * @NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK: Used with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME, this tells
1955 *	the driver to not wait for an acknowledgement. Note that due to this,
1956 *	it will also not give a status callback nor return a cookie. This is
1957 *	mostly useful for probe responses to save airtime.
1958 *
1959 * @NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS: This u32 attribute contains flags from
1960 *	&enum nl80211_feature_flags and is advertised in wiphy information.
1961 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: Indicates that the HW responds to probe
1962 *	requests while operating in AP-mode.
1963 *	This attribute holds a bitmap of the supported protocols for
1964 *	offloading (see &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr).
1965 *
1966 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response template data. Contains the entire
1967 *	probe-response frame. The DA field in the 802.11 header is zero-ed out,
1968 *	to be filled by the FW.
1969 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT: Force HT capable interfaces to disable
1970 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
1971 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1972 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT: Force VHT capable interfaces to disable
1973 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
1974 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1975 * @NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE: Force HE capable interfaces to disable
1976 *      this feature during association. This is a flag attribute.
1977 *	Currently only supported in mac80211 drivers.
1978 * @NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK: Specify which bits of the
1979 *      ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY to which attention should be paid.
1980 *      Currently, only mac80211 NICs support this feature.
1981 *      The values that may be configured are:
1982 *       MCS rates, MAX-AMSDU, HT-20-40 and HT_CAP_SGI_40
1983 *       AMPDU density and AMPDU factor.
1984 *      All values are treated as suggestions and may be ignored
1985 *      by the driver as required.  The actual values may be seen in
1986 *      the station debugfs ht_caps file.
1987 *
1988 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION: region for regulatory rules which this country
1989 *    abides to when initiating radiation on DFS channels. A country maps
1990 *    to one DFS region.
1991 *
1992 * @NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP: This u16 bitmap contains the No Ack Policy of
1993 *      up to 16 TIDs.
1994 *
1995 * @NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT: timeout value in seconds, this can be
1996 *	used by the drivers which has MLME in firmware and does not have support
1997 *	to report per station tx/rx activity to free up the station entry from
1998 *	the list. This needs to be used when the driver advertises the
1999 *	capability to timeout the stations.
2000 *
2001 * @NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM: signal strength in dBm (as a 32-bit int);
2002 *	this attribute is (depending on the driver capabilities) added to
2003 *	received frames indicated with %NL80211_CMD_FRAME.
2004 *
2005 * @NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD: Background scan period in seconds
2006 *      or 0 to disable background scan.
2007 *
2008 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE: type of regulatory hint passed from
2009 *	userspace. If unset it is assumed the hint comes directly from
2010 *	a user. If set code could specify exactly what type of source
2011 *	was used to provide the hint. For the different types of
2012 *	allowed user regulatory hints see nl80211_user_reg_hint_type.
2013 *
2014 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON: The reason for which AP has rejected
2015 *	the connection request from a station. nl80211_connect_failed_reason
2016 *	enum has different reasons of connection failure.
2017 *
2018 * @NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA: Fields and elements in Authentication frames.
2019 *	This contains the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data),
2020 *	excluding the Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the
2021 *	Authentication transaction sequence number field. It is used with
2022 *	authentication algorithms that need special fields to be added into
2023 *	the frames (SAE and FILS). Currently, only the SAE cases use the
2024 *	initial two fields (Authentication transaction sequence number and
2025 *	Status code). However, those fields are included in the attribute data
2026 *	for all authentication algorithms to keep the attribute definition
2027 *	consistent.
2028 *
2029 * @NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY: VHT Capability information element (from
2030 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2031 *
2032 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS: scan request control flags (u32)
2033 *
2034 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW: P2P GO Client Traffic Window (u8), used with
2035 *	the START_AP and SET_BSS commands
2036 * @NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS: P2P GO opportunistic PS (u8), used with the
2037 *	START_AP and SET_BSS commands. This can have the values 0 or 1;
2038 *	if not given in START_AP 0 is assumed, if not given in SET_BSS
2039 *	no change is made.
2040 *
2041 * @NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
2042 *	defined in &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode.
2043 *
2044 * @NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY: ACL policy, see &enum nl80211_acl_policy,
2045 *	carried in a u32 attribute
2046 *
2047 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS: Array of nested MAC addresses, used for
2048 *	MAC ACL.
2049 *
2050 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX: u32 attribute to advertise the maximum
2051 *	number of MAC addresses that a device can support for MAC
2052 *	ACL.
2053 *
2054 * @NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT: Type of radar event for notification to userspace,
2055 *	contains a value of enum nl80211_radar_event (u32).
2056 *
2057 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA: 802.11 extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2058 *	has and handles. The format is the same as the IE contents. See
2059 *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for more information.
2060 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK: Extended capabilities that the kernel driver
2061 *	has set in the %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA value, for multibit fields.
2062 *
2063 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY: Station capabilities (u16) are advertised to
2064 *	the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS power save (PU-APSD).
2065 *
2066 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY: Station extended capabilities are
2067 *	advertised to the driver, e.g., to enable TDLS off channel operations
2068 *	and PU-APSD.
2069 *
2070 * @NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES: global nl80211 feature flags, see
2071 *	&enum nl80211_protocol_features, the attribute is a u32.
2072 *
2073 * @NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: flag attribute, userspace supports
2074 *	receiving the data for a single wiphy split across multiple
2075 *	messages, given with wiphy dump message
2076 *
2077 * @NL80211_ATTR_MDID: Mobility Domain Identifier
2078 *
2079 * @NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC: Resource Information Container Information
2080 *	Element
2081 *
2082 * @NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID: critical protocol identifier requiring increased
2083 *	reliability, see &enum nl80211_crit_proto_id (u16).
2084 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION: duration in milliseconds in which
2085 *      the connection should have increased reliability (u16).
2086 *
2087 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID: Association ID for the peer TDLS station (u16).
2088 *	This is similar to @NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID but with a difference of being
2089 *	allowed to be used with the first @NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION command to
2090 *	update a TDLS peer STA entry.
2091 *
2092 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: Coalesce rule information.
2093 *
2094 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT: u32 attribute specifying the number of TBTT's
2095 *	until the channel switch event.
2096 * @NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX: flag attribute specifying that transmission
2097 *	must be blocked on the current channel (before the channel switch
2098 *	operation). Also included in the channel switch started event if quiet
2099 *	was requested by the AP.
2100 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES: Nested set of attributes containing the IE information
2101 *	for the time while performing a channel switch.
2102 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2103 *	switch or color change counters in the beacons tail (%NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL).
2104 * @NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP: An array of offsets (u16) to the channel
2105 *	switch or color change counters in the probe response (%NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP).
2106 *
2107 * @NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS: flags for nl80211_send_mgmt(), u32.
2108 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags.
2109 *
2110 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS: array of supported channels.
2111 *
2112 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES: array of supported
2113 *      operating classes.
2114 *
2115 * @NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS: A flag indicating whether user space
2116 *	controls DFS operation in IBSS mode. If the flag is included in
2117 *	%NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS request, the driver will allow use of DFS
2118 *	channels and reports radar events to userspace. Userspace is required
2119 *	to react to radar events, e.g. initiate a channel switch or leave the
2120 *	IBSS network.
2121 *
2122 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2123 *	5 MHz channel bandwidth.
2124 * @NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ: A flag indicating that the device supports
2125 *	10 MHz channel bandwidth.
2126 *
2127 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF: Operating mode field from Operating Mode
2128 *	Notification Element based on association request when used with
2129 *	%NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION or %NL80211_CMD_SET_STATION (only when
2130 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE is supported, or with TDLS);
2131 *	u8 attribute.
2132 *
2133 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID: The vendor ID, either a 24-bit OUI or, if
2134 *	%NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX is set, a special Linux ID (not used yet)
2135 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD: vendor sub-command
2136 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA: data for the vendor command, if any; this
2137 *	attribute is also used for vendor command feature advertisement
2138 * @NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS: used for event list advertising in the wiphy
2139 *	info, containing a nested array of possible events
2140 *
2141 * @NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP: IP DSCP mapping for Interworking QoS mapping. This
2142 *	data is in the format defined for the payload of the QoS Map Set element
2143 *	in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97.
2144 *
2145 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT: MAC address recommendation as initial BSS
2146 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT: frequency of the recommended initial BSS
2147 *
2148 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA: Device attribute that indicates how many
2149 *	associated stations are supported in AP mode (including P2P GO); u32.
2150 *	Since drivers may not have a fixed limit on the maximum number (e.g.,
2151 *	other concurrent operations may affect this), drivers are allowed to
2152 *	advertise values that cannot always be met. In such cases, an attempt
2153 *	to add a new station entry with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION may fail.
2154 *
2155 * @NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX: An array of csa counter offsets (u16) which
2156 *	should be updated when the frame is transmitted.
2157 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS: U8 attribute used to advertise the maximum
2158 *	supported number of csa counters.
2159 *
2160 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY: flags for TDLS peer capabilities, u32.
2161 *	As specified in the &enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability.
2162 *
2163 * @NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER: Flag attribute, if set during interface
2164 *	creation then the new interface will be owned by the netlink socket
2165 *	that created it and will be destroyed when the socket is closed.
2166 *	If set during scheduled scan start then the new scan req will be
2167 *	owned by the netlink socket that created it and the scheduled scan will
2168 *	be stopped when the socket is closed.
2169 *	If set during configuration of regulatory indoor operation then the
2170 *	regulatory indoor configuration would be owned by the netlink socket
2171 *	that configured the indoor setting, and the indoor operation would be
2172 *	cleared when the socket is closed.
2173 *	If set during NAN interface creation, the interface will be destroyed
2174 *	if the socket is closed just like any other interface. Moreover, NAN
2175 *	notifications will be sent in unicast to that socket. Without this
2176 *	attribute, the notifications will be sent to the %NL80211_MCGRP_NAN
2177 *	multicast group.
2178 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT the
2179 *	station will deauthenticate when the socket is closed.
2180 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_IBSS the IBSS will be automatically
2181 *	torn down when the socket is closed.
2182 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_JOIN_MESH the mesh setup will be
2183 *	automatically torn down when the socket is closed.
2184 *	If set during %NL80211_CMD_START_AP the AP will be automatically
2185 *	disabled when the socket is closed.
2186 *
2187 * @NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR: flag attribute indicating the current end is
2188 *	the TDLS link initiator.
2189 *
2190 * @NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM: flag for indicating whether the current connection
2191 *	shall support Radio Resource Measurements (11k). This attribute can be
2192 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests.
2193 *	User space applications are expected to use this flag only if the
2194 *	underlying device supports these minimal RRM features:
2195 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES,
2196 *		%NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET,
2197 *	Or, if global RRM is supported, see:
2198 *		%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM
2199 *	If this flag is used, driver must add the Power Capabilities IE to the
2200 *	association request. In addition, it must also set the RRM capability
2201 *	flag in the association request's Capability Info field.
2202 *
2203 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK: flag attribute used to enable ACK timeout
2204 *	estimation algorithm (dynack). In order to activate dynack
2205 *	%NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION feature flag must be set by lower
2206 *	drivers to indicate dynack capability. Dynack is automatically disabled
2207 *	setting valid value for coverage class.
2208 *
2209 * @NL80211_ATTR_TSID: a TSID value (u8 attribute)
2210 * @NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO: user priority value (u8 attribute)
2211 * @NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME: admitted time in units of 32 microseconds
2212 *	(per second) (u16 attribute)
2213 *
2214 * @NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE: SMPS mode to use (ap mode). see
2215 *	&enum nl80211_smps_mode.
2216 *
2217 * @NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS: operating class
2218 *
2219 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK: MAC address mask
2220 *
2221 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG: flag attribute indicating this device
2222 *	is self-managing its regulatory information and any regulatory domain
2223 *	obtained from it is coming from the device's wiphy and not the global
2224 *	cfg80211 regdomain.
2225 *
2226 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES: extended feature flags contained in a byte
2227 *	array. The feature flags are identified by their bit index (see &enum
2228 *	nl80211_ext_feature_index). The bit index is ordered starting at the
2229 *	least-significant bit of the first byte in the array, ie. bit index 0
2230 *	is located at bit 0 of byte 0. bit index 25 would be located at bit 1
2231 *	of byte 3 (u8 array).
2232 *
2233 * @NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS: Request overall radio statistics to be
2234 *	returned along with other survey data. If set, @NL80211_CMD_GET_SURVEY
2235 *	may return a survey entry without a channel indicating global radio
2236 *	statistics (only some values are valid and make sense.)
2237 *	For devices that don't return such an entry even then, the information
2238 *	should be contained in the result as the sum of the respective counters
2239 *	over all channels.
2240 *
2241 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY: delay before the first cycle of a
2242 *	scheduled scan is started.  Or the delay before a WoWLAN
2243 *	net-detect scan is started, counting from the moment the
2244 *	system is suspended.  This value is a u32, in seconds.
2245
2246 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR: flag attribute, if set indicates that the device
2247 *      is operating in an indoor environment.
2248 *
2249 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: maximum number of scan plans for
2250 *	scheduled scan supported by the device (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2251 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: maximum interval (in seconds) for
2252 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2253 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: maximum number of iterations in
2254 *	a scan plan (u32), a wiphy attribute.
2255 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS: a list of scan plans for scheduled scan.
2256 *	Each scan plan defines the number of scan iterations and the interval
2257 *	between scans. The last scan plan will always run infinitely,
2258 *	thus it must not specify the number of iterations, only the interval
2259 *	between scans. The scan plans are executed sequentially.
2260 *	Each scan plan is a nested attribute of &enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan.
2261 * @NL80211_ATTR_PBSS: flag attribute. If set it means operate
2262 *	in a PBSS. Specified in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to request
2263 *	connecting to a PCP, and in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP to start
2264 *	a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG networks only.
2265 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT: nested attribute for driver supporting the
2266 *	BSS selection feature. When used with %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY it contains
2267 *	attributes according &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr to indicate what
2268 *	BSS selection behaviours are supported. When used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
2269 *	it contains the behaviour-specific attribute containing the parameters for
2270 *	BSS selection to be done by driver and/or firmware.
2271 *
2272 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS: whether P2P PS mechanism supported
2273 *	or not. u8, one of the values of &enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status
2274 *
2275 * @NL80211_ATTR_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
2276 *
2277 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA: Nested attribute of the following attributes:
2278 *	%NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE, %NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2279 *	%NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK, to specify the extended capabilities per
2280 *	interface type.
2281 *
2282 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA: array of 24 bytes that defines a MU-MIMO
2283 *	groupID for monitor mode.
2284 *	The first 8 bytes are a mask that defines the membership in each
2285 *	group (there are 64 groups, group 0 and 63 are reserved),
2286 *	each bit represents a group and set to 1 for being a member in
2287 *	that group and 0 for not being a member.
2288 *	The remaining 16 bytes define the position in each group: 2 bits for
2289 *	each group.
2290 *	(smaller group numbers represented on most significant bits and bigger
2291 *	group numbers on least significant bits.)
2292 *	This attribute is used only if all interfaces are in monitor mode.
2293 *	Set this attribute in order to monitor packets using the given MU-MIMO
2294 *	groupID data.
2295 *	to turn off that feature set all the bits of the groupID to zero.
2296 * @NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR: mac address for the sniffer to follow
2297 *	when using MU-MIMO air sniffer.
2298 *	to turn that feature off set an invalid mac address
2299 *	(e.g. FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF)
2300 *
2301 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF: The time at which the scan was actually
2302 *	started (u64). The time is the TSF of the BSS the interface that
2303 *	requested the scan is connected to (if available, otherwise this
2304 *	attribute must not be included).
2305 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID: The BSS according to which
2306 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF is set.
2307 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION: measurement duration in TUs (u16). If
2308 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY is not set, this is the
2309 *	maximum measurement duration allowed. This attribute is used with
2310 *	measurement requests. It can also be used with %NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN
2311 *	if the scan is used for beacon report radio measurement.
2312 * @NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY: flag attribute that indicates
2313 *	that the duration specified with %NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION is
2314 *	mandatory. If this flag is not set, the duration is the maximum duration
2315 *	and the actual measurement duration may be shorter.
2316 *
2317 * @NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID: Association ID for the mesh peer (u16). This is
2318 *	used to pull the stored data for mesh peer in power save state.
2319 *
2320 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF: the master preference to be used by
2321 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and optionally with
2322 *	%NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG. Its type is u8 and it can't be 0.
2323 *	Also, values 1 and 255 are reserved for certification purposes and
2324 *	should not be used during a normal device operation.
2325 * @NL80211_ATTR_BANDS: operating bands configuration.  This is a u32
2326 *	bitmask of BIT(NL80211_BAND_*) as described in %enum
2327 *	nl80211_band.  For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0
2328 *	would be set.  This attribute is used with
2329 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_NAN and %NL80211_CMD_CHANGE_NAN_CONFIG, and
2330 *	it is optional.  If no bands are set, it means don't-care and
2331 *	the device will decide what to use.
2332 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC: a function that can be added to NAN. See
2333 *	&enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes for description of this nested
2334 *	attribute.
2335 * @NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH: used to report a match. This is a nested attribute.
2336 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes.
2337 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK: KEK for FILS (Re)Association Request/Response frame
2338 *	protection.
2339 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES: Nonces (part of AAD) for FILS (Re)Association
2340 *	Request/Response frame protection. This attribute contains the 16 octet
2341 *	STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2342 *
2343 * @NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED: Indicates whether or not multicast
2344 *	packets should be send out as unicast to all stations (flag attribute).
2345 *
2346 * @NL80211_ATTR_BSSID: The BSSID of the AP. Note that %NL80211_ATTR_MAC is also
2347 *	used in various commands/events for specifying the BSSID.
2348 *
2349 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: Relative RSSI threshold by which
2350 *	other BSSs has to be better or slightly worse than the current
2351 *	connected BSS so that they get reported to user space.
2352 *	This will give an opportunity to userspace to consider connecting to
2353 *	other matching BSSs which have better or slightly worse RSSI than
2354 *	the current connected BSS by using an offloaded operation to avoid
2355 *	unnecessary wakeups.
2356 *
2357 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for BSSs in
2358 *	the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
2359 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI based comparison to figure out
2360 *	better BSSs. The attribute value is a packed structure
2361 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
2362 *
2363 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON: The reason for which an operation timed out.
2364 *	u32 attribute with an &enum nl80211_timeout_reason value. This is used,
2365 *	e.g., with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT event.
2366 *
2367 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP)
2368 *	username part of NAI used to refer keys rRK and rIK. This is used with
2369 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2370 *
2371 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM: EAP Re-authentication Protocol (ERP) realm part
2372 *	of NAI specifying the domain name of the ER server. This is used with
2373 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2374 *
2375 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM: Unsigned 16-bit ERP next sequence number
2376 *	to use in ERP messages. This is used in generating the FILS wrapped data
2377 *	for FILS authentication and is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2378 *
2379 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) for the
2380 *	NAI specified by %NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME and
2381 *	%NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM. This is used for generating rIK and rMSK
2382 *	from successful FILS authentication and is used with
2383 *	%NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2384 *
2385 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID: A 2-octet identifier advertized by a FILS AP
2386 *	identifying the scope of PMKSAs. This is used with
2387 *	@NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA and @NL80211_CMD_DEL_PMKSA.
2388 *
2389 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK: attribute for passing PMK key material. Used with
2390 *	%NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA for the PMKSA identified by %NL80211_ATTR_PMKID.
2391 *	For %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP it is used to provide
2392 *	PSK for offloading 4-way handshake for WPA/WPA2-PSK networks. For 802.1X
2393 *	authentication it is used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMK. For offloaded FT
2394 *	support this attribute specifies the PMK-R0 if NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME
2395 *	is included as well.
2396 *
2397 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI: flag attribute which user-space shall use to
2398 *	indicate that it supports multiple active scheduled scan requests.
2399 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS: indicates maximum number of scheduled
2400 *	scan request that may be active for the device (u32).
2401 *
2402 * @NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS: flag attribute which user-space can include
2403 *	in %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to indicate that for 802.1X authentication it
2404 *	wants to use the supported offload of the 4-way handshake.
2405 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME: PMK-R0 Name for offloaded FT.
2406 * @NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED: (reserved)
2407 *
2408 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION: Identify the requested external
2409 *     authentication operation (u32 attribute with an
2410 *     &enum nl80211_external_auth_action value). This is used with the
2411 *     %NL80211_CMD_EXTERNAL_AUTH request event.
2412 * @NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: Flag attribute indicating that the user
2413 *	space supports external authentication. This attribute shall be used
2414 *	with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT and %NL80211_CMD_START_AP request. The driver
2415 *	may offload authentication processing to user space if this capability
2416 *	is indicated in the respective requests from the user space.
2417 *
2418 * @NL80211_ATTR_NSS: Station's New/updated  RX_NSS value notified using this
2419 *	u8 attribute. This is used with %NL80211_CMD_STA_OPMODE_CHANGED.
2420 *
2421 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS: TXQ statistics (nested attribute, see &enum
2422 *      nl80211_txq_stats)
2423 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT: Total packet limit for the TXQ queues for this phy.
2424 *      The smaller of this and the memory limit is enforced.
2425 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: Total memory limit (in bytes) for the
2426 *      TXQ queues for this phy. The smaller of this and the packet limit is
2427 *      enforced.
2428 * @NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum (bytes). Number of bytes
2429 *      a flow is assigned on each round of the DRR scheduler.
2430 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY: HE Capability information element (from
2431 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION). Can be set
2432 *	only if %NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME is set.
2433 *
2434 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER: nested attribute which user-space can include
2435 *	in %NL80211_CMD_START_AP or %NL80211_CMD_SET_BEACON for fine timing
2436 *	measurement (FTM) responder functionality and containing parameters as
2437 *	possible, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attr
2438 *
2439 * @NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS: Nested attribute with FTM responder
2440 *	statistics, see &enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats.
2441 *
2442 * @NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT: Timeout for the given operation in milliseconds (u32),
2443 *	if the attribute is not given no timeout is requested. Note that 0 is an
2444 *	invalid value.
2445 *
2446 * @NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS: peer measurements request (and result)
2447 *	data, uses nested attributes specified in
2448 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs.
2449 *	This is also used for capability advertisement in the wiphy information,
2450 *	with the appropriate sub-attributes.
2451 *
2452 * @NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: Station's weight when scheduled by the airtime
2453 *	scheduler.
2454 *
2455 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING: Transmit power setting type (u8) for
2456 *	station associated with the AP. See &enum nl80211_tx_power_setting for
2457 *	possible values.
2458 * @NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER: Transmit power level (s16) in dBm units. This
2459 *	allows to set Tx power for a station. If this attribute is not included,
2460 *	the default per-interface tx power setting will be overriding. Driver
2461 *	should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx power per-interface
2462 *	or per-station.
2463 *
2464 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD: attribute for passing SAE password material. It
2465 *	is used with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to provide password for offloading
2466 *	SAE authentication for WPA3-Personal networks.
2467 *
2468 * @NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER: Enable target wait time responder support.
2469 *
2470 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD: nested attribute for OBSS Packet Detection
2471 *	functionality.
2472 *
2473 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
2474 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
2475 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251. (u8 attribute)
2476 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
2477 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations. (u8 attribute)
2478 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
2479 *
2480 * @NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID: VLAN ID (1..4094) for the station and VLAN group key
2481 *	(u16).
2482 *
2483 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR: nested attribute for BSS Color Settings.
2484 *
2485 * @NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES: nested array attribute, with each entry
2486 *	using attributes from &enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes. This
2487 *	attribute is sent in a response to %NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY indicating
2488 *	supported AKM suites capability per interface. AKMs advertised in
2489 *	%NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES are default capabilities if AKM suites not
2490 *	advertised for a specific interface type.
2491 *
2492 * @NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG: TID specific configuration in a
2493 *	nested attribute with &enum nl80211_tid_config_attr sub-attributes;
2494 *	on output (in wiphy attributes) it contains only the feature sub-
2495 *	attributes.
2496 *
2497 * @NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: disable preauth frame rx on control
2498 *	port in order to forward/receive them as ordinary data frames.
2499 *
2500 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds (u32,
2501 *	dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold; 0 is not a valid value).
2502 *	An optional parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA.
2503 *	Drivers that trigger roaming need to know the lifetime of the
2504 *	configured PMKSA for triggering the full vs. PMKSA caching based
2505 *	authentication. This timeout helps authentication methods like SAE,
2506 *	where PMK gets updated only by going through a full (new SAE)
2507 *	authentication instead of getting updated during an association for EAP
2508 *	authentication. No new full authentication within the PMK expiry shall
2509 *	result in a disassociation at the end of the lifetime.
2510 *
2511 * @NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD: Reauthentication threshold time, in
2512 *	terms of percentage of %NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME
2513 *	(u8, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold, 1..100). This is an optional
2514 *	parameter configured through %NL80211_CMD_SET_PMKSA. Requests the
2515 *	driver to trigger a full authentication roam (without PMKSA caching)
2516 *	after the reauthentication threshold time, but before the PMK lifetime
2517 *	has expired.
2518 *
2519 *	Authentication methods like SAE need to be able to generate a new PMKSA
2520 *	entry without having to force a disconnection after the PMK timeout. If
2521 *	no roaming occurs between the reauth threshold and PMK expiration,
2522 *	disassociation is still forced.
2523 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST: multicast flag for the
2524 *	%NL80211_CMD_REGISTER_FRAME command, see the description there.
2525 * @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET: offset of the associated
2526 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ in positive KHz. Only valid when supplied with
2527 *	an %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET.
2528 * @NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET: Center frequency offset in KHz for the
2529 *	first channel segment specified in %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1.
2530 * @NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: nested attribute with KHz frequencies
2531 *
2532 * @NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY: HE 6 GHz Band Capability element (from
2533 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION).
2534 *
2535 * @NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY: Optional parameter to configure FILS
2536 *	discovery. It is a nested attribute, see
2537 *	&enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes.
2538 *
2539 * @NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Optional parameter to configure
2540 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response. It is a nested attribute, see
2541 *	&enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes.
2542 *
2543 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY: S1G Capability information element (from
2544 *	association request when used with NL80211_CMD_NEW_STATION)
2545 * @NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK: S1G Capability Information element
2546 *	override mask. Used with NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY in
2547 *	NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE or NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
2548 *
2549 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE: Indicates the mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
2550 *	derivation in WPA3-Personal networks which are using SAE authentication.
2551 *	This is a u8 attribute that encapsulates one of the values from
2552 *	&enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism.
2553 *
2554 * @NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC: SAR power limitation specification when
2555 *	used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPECS. The message contains fields
2556 *	of %nl80211_sar_attrs which specifies the sar type and related
2557 *	sar specs. Sar specs contains array of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
2558 *
2559 * @NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED: flag attribute, used with deauth and
2560 *	disassoc events to indicate that an immediate reconnect to the AP
2561 *	is desired.
2562 *
2563 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR: total number of nl80211_attrs available
2564 * @NL80211_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number currently defined
2565 * @__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
2566 */
2567enum nl80211_attrs {
2568/* don't change the order or add anything between, this is ABI! */
2569	NL80211_ATTR_UNSPEC,
2570
2571	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY,
2572	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_NAME,
2573
2574	NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX,
2575	NL80211_ATTR_IFNAME,
2576	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE,
2577
2578	NL80211_ATTR_MAC,
2579
2580	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DATA,
2581	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_IDX,
2582	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_CIPHER,
2583	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_SEQ,
2584	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT,
2585
2586	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_INTERVAL,
2587	NL80211_ATTR_DTIM_PERIOD,
2588	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_HEAD,
2589	NL80211_ATTR_BEACON_TAIL,
2590
2591	NL80211_ATTR_STA_AID,
2592	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS,
2593	NL80211_ATTR_STA_LISTEN_INTERVAL,
2594	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_RATES,
2595	NL80211_ATTR_STA_VLAN,
2596	NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO,
2597
2598	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_BANDS,
2599
2600	NL80211_ATTR_MNTR_FLAGS,
2601
2602	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_ID,
2603	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_ACTION,
2604	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_NEXT_HOP,
2605	NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO,
2606
2607	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_CTS_PROT,
2608	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
2609	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
2610
2611	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY,
2612
2613	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_IFTYPES,
2614
2615	NL80211_ATTR_REG_ALPHA2,
2616	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULES,
2617
2618	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG,
2619
2620	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES,
2621
2622	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS,
2623	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ,
2624	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE,
2625
2626	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
2627
2628	NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE,
2629	NL80211_ATTR_IE,
2630
2631	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCAN_SSIDS,
2632
2633	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES,
2634	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SSIDS,
2635	NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION, /* replaces old SCAN_GENERATION */
2636	NL80211_ATTR_BSS,
2637
2638	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR,
2639	NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE,
2640
2641	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORTED_COMMANDS,
2642
2643	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME,
2644	NL80211_ATTR_SSID,
2645	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE,
2646	NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE,
2647
2648	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_TYPE,
2649
2650	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2651	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES,
2652
2653	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_BEFORE,
2654	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_AFTER,
2655
2656	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_FIXED,
2657
2658
2659	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_SHORT,
2660	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RETRY_LONG,
2661	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FRAG_THRESHOLD,
2662	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_RTS_THRESHOLD,
2663
2664	NL80211_ATTR_TIMED_OUT,
2665
2666	NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP,
2667
2668	NL80211_ATTR_STA_FLAGS2,
2669
2670	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT,
2671
2672	NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA,
2673
2674	NL80211_ATTR_PRIVACY,
2675
2676	NL80211_ATTR_DISCONNECTED_BY_AP,
2677	NL80211_ATTR_STATUS_CODE,
2678
2679	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE,
2680	NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP,
2681	NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS,
2682	NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES,
2683
2684	NL80211_ATTR_REQ_IE,
2685	NL80211_ATTR_RESP_IE,
2686
2687	NL80211_ATTR_PREV_BSSID,
2688
2689	NL80211_ATTR_KEY,
2690	NL80211_ATTR_KEYS,
2691
2692	NL80211_ATTR_PID,
2693
2694	NL80211_ATTR_4ADDR,
2695
2696	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO,
2697
2698	NL80211_ATTR_PMKID,
2699	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_PMKIDS,
2700
2701	NL80211_ATTR_DURATION,
2702
2703	NL80211_ATTR_COOKIE,
2704
2705	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_COVERAGE_CLASS,
2706
2707	NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES,
2708
2709	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_MATCH,
2710
2711	NL80211_ATTR_ACK,
2712
2713	NL80211_ATTR_PS_STATE,
2714
2715	NL80211_ATTR_CQM,
2716
2717	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_STATE_CHANGE,
2718
2719	NL80211_ATTR_AP_ISOLATE,
2720
2721	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_SETTING,
2722	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TX_POWER_LEVEL,
2723
2724	NL80211_ATTR_TX_FRAME_TYPES,
2725	NL80211_ATTR_RX_FRAME_TYPES,
2726	NL80211_ATTR_FRAME_TYPE,
2727
2728	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_ETHERTYPE,
2729	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_ENCRYPT,
2730
2731	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_IBSS_RSN,
2732
2733	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX,
2734	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_RX,
2735
2736	NL80211_ATTR_MCAST_RATE,
2737
2738	NL80211_ATTR_OFFCHANNEL_TX_OK,
2739
2740	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_HT_OPMODE,
2741
2742	NL80211_ATTR_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
2743
2744	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_DURATION,
2745
2746	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_SETUP,
2747
2748	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_TX,
2749	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_AVAIL_RX,
2750
2751	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_MESH_AUTH,
2752	NL80211_ATTR_STA_PLINK_STATE,
2753
2754	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS,
2755	NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED,
2756
2757	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_INTERVAL,
2758
2759	NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS,
2760	NL80211_ATTR_SOFTWARE_IFTYPES,
2761
2762	NL80211_ATTR_REKEY_DATA,
2763
2764	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_SSIDS,
2765	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCHED_SCAN_IE_LEN,
2766
2767	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_SUPP_RATES,
2768
2769	NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID,
2770
2771	NL80211_ATTR_IE_PROBE_RESP,
2772	NL80211_ATTR_IE_ASSOC_RESP,
2773
2774	NL80211_ATTR_STA_WME,
2775	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_AP_UAPSD,
2776
2777	NL80211_ATTR_ROAM_SUPPORT,
2778
2779	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH,
2780	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_MATCH_SETS,
2781
2782	NL80211_ATTR_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
2783
2784	NL80211_ATTR_TX_NO_CCK_RATE,
2785
2786	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_ACTION,
2787	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_DIALOG_TOKEN,
2788	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION,
2789	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_SUPPORT,
2790	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP,
2791
2792	NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME,
2793
2794	NL80211_ATTR_DONT_WAIT_FOR_ACK,
2795
2796	NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS,
2797
2798	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD,
2799
2800	NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP,
2801
2802	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_REGION,
2803
2804	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HT,
2805	NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2806
2807	NL80211_ATTR_NOACK_MAP,
2808
2809	NL80211_ATTR_INACTIVITY_TIMEOUT,
2810
2811	NL80211_ATTR_RX_SIGNAL_DBM,
2812
2813	NL80211_ATTR_BG_SCAN_PERIOD,
2814
2815	NL80211_ATTR_WDEV,
2816
2817	NL80211_ATTR_USER_REG_HINT_TYPE,
2818
2819	NL80211_ATTR_CONN_FAILED_REASON,
2820
2821	NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA,
2822
2823	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY,
2824
2825	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FLAGS,
2826
2827	NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH,
2828	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1,
2829	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2,
2830
2831	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_CTWINDOW,
2832	NL80211_ATTR_P2P_OPPPS,
2833
2834	NL80211_ATTR_LOCAL_MESH_POWER_MODE,
2835
2836	NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY,
2837
2838	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ADDRS,
2839
2840	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_ACL_MAX,
2841
2842	NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT,
2843
2844	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA,
2845	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_CAPA_MASK,
2846
2847	NL80211_ATTR_STA_CAPABILITY,
2848	NL80211_ATTR_STA_EXT_CAPABILITY,
2849
2850	NL80211_ATTR_PROTOCOL_FEATURES,
2851	NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP,
2852
2853	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_VHT,
2854	NL80211_ATTR_VHT_CAPABILITY_MASK,
2855
2856	NL80211_ATTR_MDID,
2857	NL80211_ATTR_IE_RIC,
2858
2859	NL80211_ATTR_CRIT_PROT_ID,
2860	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CRIT_PROT_DURATION,
2861
2862	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_AID,
2863
2864	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
2865
2866	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_COUNT,
2867	NL80211_ATTR_CH_SWITCH_BLOCK_TX,
2868	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_IES,
2869	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON,
2870	NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP,
2871
2872	NL80211_ATTR_RXMGMT_FLAGS,
2873
2874	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_CHANNELS,
2875
2876	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORTED_OPER_CLASSES,
2877
2878	NL80211_ATTR_HANDLE_DFS,
2879
2880	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_5_MHZ,
2881	NL80211_ATTR_SUPPORT_10_MHZ,
2882
2883	NL80211_ATTR_OPMODE_NOTIF,
2884
2885	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_ID,
2886	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_SUBCMD,
2887	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
2888	NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_EVENTS,
2889
2890	NL80211_ATTR_QOS_MAP,
2891
2892	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_HINT,
2893	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_HINT,
2894
2895	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_AP_ASSOC_STA,
2896
2897	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_PEER_CAPABILITY,
2898
2899	NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER,
2900
2901	NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFFSETS_TX,
2902	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS,
2903
2904	NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_INITIATOR,
2905
2906	NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM,
2907
2908	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK,
2909
2910	NL80211_ATTR_TSID,
2911	NL80211_ATTR_USER_PRIO,
2912	NL80211_ATTR_ADMITTED_TIME,
2913
2914	NL80211_ATTR_SMPS_MODE,
2915
2916	NL80211_ATTR_OPER_CLASS,
2917
2918	NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK,
2919
2920	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED_REG,
2921
2922	NL80211_ATTR_EXT_FEATURES,
2923
2924	NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_RADIO_STATS,
2925
2926	NL80211_ATTR_NETNS_FD,
2927
2928	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_DELAY,
2929
2930	NL80211_ATTR_REG_INDOOR,
2931
2932	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_NUM_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2933	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
2934	NL80211_ATTR_MAX_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
2935	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_PLANS,
2936
2937	NL80211_ATTR_PBSS,
2938
2939	NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT,
2940
2941	NL80211_ATTR_STA_SUPPORT_P2P_PS,
2942
2943	NL80211_ATTR_PAD,
2944
2945	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_EXT_CAPA,
2946
2947	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA,
2948	NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR,
2949
2950	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF,
2951	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_START_TIME_TSF_BSSID,
2952	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION,
2953	NL80211_ATTR_MEASUREMENT_DURATION_MANDATORY,
2954
2955	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PEER_AID,
2956
2957	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MASTER_PREF,
2958	NL80211_ATTR_BANDS,
2959	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_FUNC,
2960	NL80211_ATTR_NAN_MATCH,
2961
2962	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_KEK,
2963	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_NONCES,
2964
2965	NL80211_ATTR_MULTICAST_TO_UNICAST_ENABLED,
2966
2967	NL80211_ATTR_BSSID,
2968
2969	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
2970	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RSSI_ADJUST,
2971
2972	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT_REASON,
2973
2974	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_USERNAME,
2975	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_REALM,
2976	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_NEXT_SEQ_NUM,
2977	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_ERP_RRK,
2978	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_CACHE_ID,
2979
2980	NL80211_ATTR_PMK,
2981
2982	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MULTI,
2983	NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MAX_REQS,
2984
2985	NL80211_ATTR_WANT_1X_4WAY_HS,
2986	NL80211_ATTR_PMKR0_NAME,
2987	NL80211_ATTR_PORT_AUTHORIZED,
2988
2989	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION,
2990	NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT,
2991
2992	NL80211_ATTR_NSS,
2993	NL80211_ATTR_ACK_SIGNAL,
2994
2995	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
2996
2997	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_STATS,
2998	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_LIMIT,
2999	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT,
3000	NL80211_ATTR_TXQ_QUANTUM,
3001
3002	NL80211_ATTR_HE_CAPABILITY,
3003
3004	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER,
3005
3006	NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS,
3007
3008	NL80211_ATTR_TIMEOUT,
3009
3010	NL80211_ATTR_PEER_MEASUREMENTS,
3011
3012	NL80211_ATTR_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3013	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER_SETTING,
3014	NL80211_ATTR_STA_TX_POWER,
3015
3016	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PASSWORD,
3017
3018	NL80211_ATTR_TWT_RESPONDER,
3019
3020	NL80211_ATTR_HE_OBSS_PD,
3021
3022	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3023	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3024
3025	NL80211_ATTR_VLAN_ID,
3026
3027	NL80211_ATTR_HE_BSS_COLOR,
3028
3029	NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE_AKM_SUITES,
3030
3031	NL80211_ATTR_TID_CONFIG,
3032
3033	NL80211_ATTR_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
3034
3035	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_LIFETIME,
3036	NL80211_ATTR_PMK_REAUTH_THRESHOLD,
3037
3038	NL80211_ATTR_RECEIVE_MULTICAST,
3039	NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ_OFFSET,
3040	NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1_OFFSET,
3041	NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
3042
3043	NL80211_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPABILITY,
3044
3045	NL80211_ATTR_FILS_DISCOVERY,
3046
3047	NL80211_ATTR_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
3048
3049	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY,
3050	NL80211_ATTR_S1G_CAPABILITY_MASK,
3051
3052	NL80211_ATTR_SAE_PWE,
3053
3054	NL80211_ATTR_RECONNECT_REQUESTED,
3055
3056	NL80211_ATTR_SAR_SPEC,
3057
3058	NL80211_ATTR_DISABLE_HE,
3059
3060	/* add attributes here, update the policy in nl80211.c */
3061
3062	__NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3063	NUM_NL80211_ATTR = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3064	NL80211_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3065};
3066
3067/* source-level API compatibility */
3068#define NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_GENERATION NL80211_ATTR_GENERATION
3069#define	NL80211_ATTR_MESH_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_MESH_CONFIG
3070#define NL80211_ATTR_IFACE_SOCKET_OWNER NL80211_ATTR_SOCKET_OWNER
3071#define NL80211_ATTR_SAE_DATA NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_DATA
3072#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_BEACON NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_BEACON
3073#define NL80211_ATTR_CSA_C_OFF_PRESP NL80211_ATTR_CNTDWN_OFFS_PRESP
3074
3075/*
3076 * Allow user space programs to use #ifdef on new attributes by defining them
3077 * here
3078 */
3079#define NL80211_CMD_CONNECT NL80211_CMD_CONNECT
3080#define NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY NL80211_ATTR_HT_CAPABILITY
3081#define NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES NL80211_ATTR_BSS_BASIC_RATES
3082#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_TXQ_PARAMS
3083#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ
3084#define NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_CHANNEL_TYPE
3085#define NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE NL80211_ATTR_MGMT_SUBTYPE
3086#define NL80211_ATTR_IE NL80211_ATTR_IE
3087#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR NL80211_ATTR_REG_INITIATOR
3088#define NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_REG_TYPE
3089#define NL80211_ATTR_FRAME NL80211_ATTR_FRAME
3090#define NL80211_ATTR_SSID NL80211_ATTR_SSID
3091#define NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE NL80211_ATTR_AUTH_TYPE
3092#define NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE NL80211_ATTR_REASON_CODE
3093#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITES_PAIRWISE
3094#define NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP NL80211_ATTR_CIPHER_SUITE_GROUP
3095#define NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS NL80211_ATTR_WPA_VERSIONS
3096#define NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES NL80211_ATTR_AKM_SUITES
3097#define NL80211_ATTR_KEY NL80211_ATTR_KEY
3098#define NL80211_ATTR_KEYS NL80211_ATTR_KEYS
3099#define NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS NL80211_ATTR_FEATURE_FLAGS
3100
3101#define NL80211_WIPHY_NAME_MAXLEN		64
3102
3103#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES			32
3104#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_HT_RATES		77
3105#define NL80211_MAX_SUPP_REG_RULES		128
3106#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_ENCR_KEY	0
3107#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_TX_MIC_KEY	16
3108#define NL80211_TKIP_DATA_OFFSET_RX_MIC_KEY	24
3109#define NL80211_HT_CAPABILITY_LEN		26
3110#define NL80211_VHT_CAPABILITY_LEN		12
3111#define NL80211_HE_MIN_CAPABILITY_LEN           16
3112#define NL80211_HE_MAX_CAPABILITY_LEN           54
3113#define NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES		5
3114#define NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES		2
3115
3116#define NL80211_MIN_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL_TIME	10
3117
3118/* default RSSI threshold for scan results if none specified. */
3119#define NL80211_SCAN_RSSI_THOLD_OFF		-300
3120
3121#define NL80211_CQM_TXE_MAX_INTVL		1800
3122
3123/**
3124 * enum nl80211_iftype - (virtual) interface types
3125 *
3126 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified type, driver decides
3127 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC: independent BSS member
3128 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION: managed BSS member
3129 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP: access point
3130 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN: VLAN interface for access points; VLAN interfaces
3131 *	are a bit special in that they must always be tied to a pre-existing
3132 *	AP type interface.
3133 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS: wireless distribution interface
3134 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR: monitor interface receiving all frames
3135 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT: mesh point
3136 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT: P2P client
3137 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO: P2P group owner
3138 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE: P2P device interface type, this is not a netdev
3139 *	and therefore can't be created in the normal ways, use the
3140 *	%NL80211_CMD_START_P2P_DEVICE and %NL80211_CMD_STOP_P2P_DEVICE
3141 *	commands to create and destroy one
3142 * @NL80211_IF_TYPE_OCB: Outside Context of a BSS
3143 *	This mode corresponds to the MIB variable dot11OCBActivated=true
3144 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN: NAN device interface type (not a netdev)
3145 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX: highest interface type number currently defined
3146 * @NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES: number of defined interface types
3147 *
3148 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_IFTYPE
3149 * to set the type of an interface.
3150 *
3151 */
3152enum nl80211_iftype {
3153	NL80211_IFTYPE_UNSPECIFIED,
3154	NL80211_IFTYPE_ADHOC,
3155	NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION,
3156	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP,
3157	NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN,
3158	NL80211_IFTYPE_WDS,
3159	NL80211_IFTYPE_MONITOR,
3160	NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT,
3161	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT,
3162	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO,
3163	NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_DEVICE,
3164	NL80211_IFTYPE_OCB,
3165	NL80211_IFTYPE_NAN,
3166
3167	/* keep last */
3168	NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES,
3169	NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES - 1
3170};
3171
3172/**
3173 * enum nl80211_sta_flags - station flags
3174 *
3175 * Station flags. When a station is added to an AP interface, it is
3176 * assumed to be already associated (and hence authenticated.)
3177 *
3178 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3179 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
3180 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE: station is capable of receiving frames
3181 *	with short barker preamble
3182 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME: station is WME/QoS capable
3183 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP: station uses management frame protection
3184 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED: station is authenticated
3185 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER: station is a TDLS peer -- this flag should
3186 *	only be used in managed mode (even in the flags mask). Note that the
3187 *	flag can't be changed, it is only valid while adding a station, and
3188 *	attempts to change it will silently be ignored (rather than rejected
3189 *	as errors.)
3190 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED: station is associated; used with drivers
3191 *	that support %NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE to transition a
3192 *	previously added station into associated state
3193 * @NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX: highest station flag number currently defined
3194 * @__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3195 */
3196enum nl80211_sta_flags {
3197	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_INVALID,
3198	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED,
3199	NL80211_STA_FLAG_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3200	NL80211_STA_FLAG_WME,
3201	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MFP,
3202	NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHENTICATED,
3203	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER,
3204	NL80211_STA_FLAG_ASSOCIATED,
3205
3206	/* keep last */
3207	__NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
3208	NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_STA_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
3209};
3210
3211/**
3212 * enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status - station support of P2P PS
3213 *
3214 * @NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED: station doesn't support P2P PS mechanism
3215 * @@NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED: station supports P2P PS mechanism
3216 * @NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS: number of values
3217 */
3218enum nl80211_sta_p2p_ps_status {
3219	NL80211_P2P_PS_UNSUPPORTED = 0,
3220	NL80211_P2P_PS_SUPPORTED,
3221
3222	NUM_NL80211_P2P_PS_STATUS,
3223};
3224
3225#define NL80211_STA_FLAG_MAX_OLD_API	NL80211_STA_FLAG_TDLS_PEER
3226
3227/**
3228 * struct nl80211_sta_flag_update - station flags mask/set
3229 * @mask: mask of station flags to set
3230 * @set: which values to set them to
3231 *
3232 * Both mask and set contain bits as per &enum nl80211_sta_flags.
3233 */
3234struct nl80211_sta_flag_update {
3235	__u32 mask;
3236	__u32 set;
3237} __attribute__((packed));
3238
3239/**
3240 * enum nl80211_he_gi - HE guard interval
3241 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8: 0.8 usec
3242 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6: 1.6 usec
3243 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2: 3.2 usec
3244 */
3245enum nl80211_he_gi {
3246	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_0_8,
3247	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_1_6,
3248	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI_3_2,
3249};
3250
3251/**
3252 * enum nl80211_he_ltf - HE long training field
3253 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1xLTF: 3.2 usec
3254 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2xLTF: 6.4 usec
3255 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4xLTF: 12.8 usec
3256 */
3257enum nl80211_he_ltf {
3258	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_1XLTF,
3259	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_2XLTF,
3260	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_4XLTF,
3261};
3262
3263/**
3264 * enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc - HE RU allocation values
3265 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26: 26-tone RU allocation
3266 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52: 52-tone RU allocation
3267 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106: 106-tone RU allocation
3268 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242: 242-tone RU allocation
3269 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484: 484-tone RU allocation
3270 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996: 996-tone RU allocation
3271 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996: 2x996-tone RU allocation
3272 */
3273enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc {
3274	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_26,
3275	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_52,
3276	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_106,
3277	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_242,
3278	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_484,
3279	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_996,
3280	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC_2x996,
3281};
3282
3283/**
3284 * enum nl80211_rate_info - bitrate information
3285 *
3286 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_TXRATE
3287 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3288 * There are 2 attributes for bitrate, a legacy one that represents
3289 * a 16-bit value, and new one that represents a 32-bit value.
3290 * If the rate value fits into 16 bit, both attributes are reported
3291 * with the same value. If the rate is too high to fit into 16 bits
3292 * (>6.5535Gbps) only 32-bit attribute is included.
3293 * User space tools encouraged to use the 32-bit attribute and fall
3294 * back to the 16-bit one for compatibility with older kernels.
3295 *
3296 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3297 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE: total bitrate (u16, 100kbit/s)
3298 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS: mcs index for 802.11n (u8)
3299 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH: 40 MHz dualchannel bitrate
3300 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
3301 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32: total bitrate (u32, 100kbit/s)
3302 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX: highest rate_info number currently defined
3303 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS: MCS index for VHT (u8)
3304 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS: number of streams in VHT (u8)
3305 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH: 80 MHz VHT rate
3306 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH: unused - 80+80 is treated the
3307 *	same as 160 for purposes of the bitrates
3308 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH: 160 MHz VHT rate
3309 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH: 10 MHz width - note that this is
3310 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3311 *	half the base (20 MHz) rate
3312 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH: 5 MHz width - note that this is
3313 *	a legacy rate and will be reported as the actual bitrate, i.e.
3314 *	a quarter of the base (20 MHz) rate
3315 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS: HE MCS index (u8, 0-11)
3316 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS: HE NSS value (u8, 1-8)
3317 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI: HE guard interval identifier
3318 *	(u8, see &enum nl80211_he_gi)
3319 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM: HE DCM value (u8, 0/1)
3320 * @NL80211_RATE_INFO_RU_ALLOC: HE RU allocation, if not present then
3321 *	non-OFDMA was used (u8, see &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc)
3322 * @__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3323 */
3324enum nl80211_rate_info {
3325	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_INVALID,
3326	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE,
3327	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MCS,
3328	NL80211_RATE_INFO_40_MHZ_WIDTH,
3329	NL80211_RATE_INFO_SHORT_GI,
3330	NL80211_RATE_INFO_BITRATE32,
3331	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_MCS,
3332	NL80211_RATE_INFO_VHT_NSS,
3333	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3334	NL80211_RATE_INFO_80P80_MHZ_WIDTH,
3335	NL80211_RATE_INFO_160_MHZ_WIDTH,
3336	NL80211_RATE_INFO_10_MHZ_WIDTH,
3337	NL80211_RATE_INFO_5_MHZ_WIDTH,
3338	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_MCS,
3339	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_NSS,
3340	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_GI,
3341	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_DCM,
3342	NL80211_RATE_INFO_HE_RU_ALLOC,
3343
3344	/* keep last */
3345	__NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3346	NL80211_RATE_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_RATE_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3347};
3348
3349/**
3350 * enum nl80211_sta_bss_param - BSS information collected by STA
3351 *
3352 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM
3353 * when getting information about the bitrate of a station.
3354 *
3355 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3356 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled (flag)
3357 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE:  whether short preamble is enabled
3358 *	(flag)
3359 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME:  whether short slot time is enabled
3360 *	(flag)
3361 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD: DTIM period for beaconing (u8)
3362 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL: Beacon interval (u16)
3363 * @NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX: highest sta_bss_param number currently defined
3364 * @__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3365 */
3366enum nl80211_sta_bss_param {
3367	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_INVALID,
3368	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_CTS_PROT,
3369	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_PREAMBLE,
3370	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_SHORT_SLOT_TIME,
3371	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_DTIM_PERIOD,
3372	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_BEACON_INTERVAL,
3373
3374	/* keep last */
3375	__NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST,
3376	NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_MAX = __NL80211_STA_BSS_PARAM_AFTER_LAST - 1
3377};
3378
3379/**
3380 * enum nl80211_sta_info - station information
3381 *
3382 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_STA_INFO
3383 * when getting information about a station.
3384 *
3385 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3386 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME: time since last activity (u32, msecs)
3387 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3388 *	(u32, from this station)
3389 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3390 *	(u32, to this station)
3391 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64: total received bytes (MPDU length)
3392 *	(u64, from this station)
3393 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64: total transmitted bytes (MPDU length)
3394 *	(u64, to this station)
3395 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL: signal strength of last received PPDU (u8, dBm)
3396 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE: current unicast tx rate, nested attribute
3397 * 	containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_rate_info
3398 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS: total received packet (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3399 *	(u32, from this station)
3400 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS: total transmitted packets (MSDUs and MMPDUs)
3401 *	(u32, to this station)
3402 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES: total retries (MPDUs) (u32, to this station)
3403 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED: total failed packets (MPDUs)
3404 *	(u32, to this station)
3405 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average (u8, dBm)
3406 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID: the station's mesh LLID
3407 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID: the station's mesh PLID
3408 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE: peer link state for the station
3409 *	(see %enum nl80211_plink_state)
3410 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE: last unicast data frame rx rate, nested
3411 *	attribute, like NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE.
3412 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM: current station's view of BSS, nested attribute
3413 *     containing info as possible, see &enum nl80211_sta_bss_param
3414 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME: time since the station is last connected
3415 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS: Contains a struct nl80211_sta_flag_update.
3416 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS: count of times beacon loss was detected (u32)
3417 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET: timing offset with respect to this STA (s64)
3418 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM: local mesh STA link-specific power mode
3419 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM: peer mesh STA link-specific power mode
3420 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM: neighbor mesh STA power save mode towards
3421 *	non-peer STA
3422 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last PPDU
3423 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm)
3424 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG: per-chain signal strength average
3425 *	Same format as NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL.
3426 * @NL80211_STA_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT: expected throughput considering also the
3427 *	802.11 header (u32, kbps)
3428 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC: RX packets dropped for unspecified reasons
3429 *	(u64)
3430 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX: number of beacons received from this peer (u64)
3431 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG: signal strength average
3432 *	for beacons only (u8, dBm)
3433 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS: per-TID statistics (see &enum nl80211_tid_stats)
3434 *	This is a nested attribute where each the inner attribute number is the
3435 *	TID+1 and the special TID 16 (i.e. value 17) is used for non-QoS frames;
3436 *	each one of those is again nested with &enum nl80211_tid_stats
3437 *	attributes carrying the actual values.
3438 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3439 *	received from the station (u64, usec)
3440 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3441 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL: signal strength of the last ACK frame(u8, dBm)
3442 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG: avg signal strength of ACK frames (s8, dBm)
3443 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS: total number of received packets (MPDUs)
3444 *	(u32, from this station)
3445 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT: total number of packets (MPDUs) received
3446 *	with an FCS error (u32, from this station). This count may not include
3447 *	some packets with an FCS error due to TA corruption. Hence this counter
3448 *	might not be fully accurate.
3449 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: set to true if STA has a path to a
3450 *	mesh gate (u8, 0 or 1)
3451 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION: aggregate PPDU duration for all frames
3452 *	sent to the station (u64, usec)
3453 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT: current airtime weight for station (u16)
3454 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC: airtime link metric for mesh station
3455 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME: Timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME, nanoseconds)
3456 *	of STA's association
3457 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS: set to true if STA has a path to a
3458 *	authentication server (u8, 0 or 1)
3459 * @__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal
3460 * @NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX: highest possible station info attribute
3461 */
3462enum nl80211_sta_info {
3463	__NL80211_STA_INFO_INVALID,
3464	NL80211_STA_INFO_INACTIVE_TIME,
3465	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES,
3466	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES,
3467	NL80211_STA_INFO_LLID,
3468	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLID,
3469	NL80211_STA_INFO_PLINK_STATE,
3470	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL,
3471	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BITRATE,
3472	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_PACKETS,
3473	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_PACKETS,
3474	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_RETRIES,
3475	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_FAILED,
3476	NL80211_STA_INFO_SIGNAL_AVG,
3477	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BITRATE,
3478	NL80211_STA_INFO_BSS_PARAM,
3479	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TIME,
3480	NL80211_STA_INFO_STA_FLAGS,
3481	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_LOSS,
3482	NL80211_STA_INFO_T_OFFSET,
3483	NL80211_STA_INFO_LOCAL_PM,
3484	NL80211_STA_INFO_PEER_PM,
3485	NL80211_STA_INFO_NONPEER_PM,
3486	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_BYTES64,
3487	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_BYTES64,
3488	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
3489	NL80211_STA_INFO_CHAIN_SIGNAL_AVG,
3490	NL80211_STA_INFO_EXPECTED_THROUGHPUT,
3491	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DROP_MISC,
3492	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_RX,
3493	NL80211_STA_INFO_BEACON_SIGNAL_AVG,
3494	NL80211_STA_INFO_TID_STATS,
3495	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_DURATION,
3496	NL80211_STA_INFO_PAD,
3497	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL,
3498	NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG,
3499	NL80211_STA_INFO_RX_MPDUS,
3500	NL80211_STA_INFO_FCS_ERROR_COUNT,
3501	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
3502	NL80211_STA_INFO_TX_DURATION,
3503	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_WEIGHT,
3504	NL80211_STA_INFO_AIRTIME_LINK_METRIC,
3505	NL80211_STA_INFO_ASSOC_AT_BOOTTIME,
3506	NL80211_STA_INFO_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
3507
3508	/* keep last */
3509	__NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3510	NL80211_STA_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_STA_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3511};
3512
3513/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
3514#define NL80211_STA_INFO_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG NL80211_STA_INFO_ACK_SIGNAL_AVG
3515
3516
3517/**
3518 * enum nl80211_tid_stats - per TID statistics attributes
3519 * @__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3520 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU: number of MSDUs received (u64)
3521 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU: number of MSDUs transmitted (or
3522 *	attempted to transmit; u64)
3523 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES: number of retries for
3524 *	transmitted MSDUs (not counting the first attempt; u64)
3525 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED: number of failed transmitted
3526 *	MSDUs (u64)
3527 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
3528 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS: TXQ stats (nested attribute)
3529 * @NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS: number of attributes here
3530 * @NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3531 */
3532enum nl80211_tid_stats {
3533	__NL80211_TID_STATS_INVALID,
3534	NL80211_TID_STATS_RX_MSDU,
3535	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU,
3536	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_RETRIES,
3537	NL80211_TID_STATS_TX_MSDU_FAILED,
3538	NL80211_TID_STATS_PAD,
3539	NL80211_TID_STATS_TXQ_STATS,
3540
3541	/* keep last */
3542	NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS,
3543	NL80211_TID_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TID_STATS - 1
3544};
3545
3546/**
3547 * enum nl80211_txq_stats - per TXQ statistics attributes
3548 * @__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3549 * @NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS: number of attributes here
3550 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES: number of bytes currently backlogged
3551 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS: number of packets currently
3552 *      backlogged
3553 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS: total number of new flows seen
3554 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS: total number of packet drops
3555 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS: total number of packet ECN marks
3556 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT: number of drops due to queue space overflow
3557 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
3558 *      (only for per-phy stats)
3559 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS: number of hash collisions
3560 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES: total number of bytes dequeued from TXQ
3561 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS: total number of packets dequeued from TXQ
3562 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS: number of flow buckets for PHY
3563 * @NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX: highest numbered attribute here
3564 */
3565enum nl80211_txq_stats {
3566	__NL80211_TXQ_STATS_INVALID,
3567	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_BYTES,
3568	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_BACKLOG_PACKETS,
3569	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_FLOWS,
3570	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_DROPS,
3571	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_ECN_MARKS,
3572	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERLIMIT,
3573	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_OVERMEMORY,
3574	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_COLLISIONS,
3575	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_BYTES,
3576	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_TX_PACKETS,
3577	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX_FLOWS,
3578
3579	/* keep last */
3580	NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS,
3581	NL80211_TXQ_STATS_MAX = NUM_NL80211_TXQ_STATS - 1
3582};
3583
3584/**
3585 * enum nl80211_mpath_flags - nl80211 mesh path flags
3586 *
3587 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE: the mesh path is active
3588 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING: the mesh path discovery process is running
3589 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID: the mesh path contains a valid SN
3590 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED: the mesh path has been manually set
3591 * @NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED: the mesh path discovery process succeeded
3592 */
3593enum nl80211_mpath_flags {
3594	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_ACTIVE =	1<<0,
3595	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVING =	1<<1,
3596	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_SN_VALID =	1<<2,
3597	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_FIXED =	1<<3,
3598	NL80211_MPATH_FLAG_RESOLVED =	1<<4,
3599};
3600
3601/**
3602 * enum nl80211_mpath_info - mesh path information
3603 *
3604 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_MPATH_INFO when getting
3605 * information about a mesh path.
3606 *
3607 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3608 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: number of queued frames for this destination
3609 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN: destination sequence number
3610 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC: metric (cost) of this mesh path
3611 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: expiration time for the path, in msec from now
3612 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: mesh path flags, enumerated in
3613 * 	&enum nl80211_mpath_flags;
3614 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: total path discovery timeout, in msec
3615 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: mesh path discovery retries
3616 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: hop count to destination
3617 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: total number of path changes to destination
3618 * @NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX: highest mesh path information attribute number
3619 *	currently defined
3620 * @__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3621 */
3622enum nl80211_mpath_info {
3623	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_INVALID,
3624	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN,
3625	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_SN,
3626	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_METRIC,
3627	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME,
3628	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_FLAGS,
3629	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
3630	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES,
3631	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT,
3632	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE,
3633
3634	/* keep last */
3635	__NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
3636	NL80211_MPATH_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_MPATH_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
3637};
3638
3639/**
3640 * enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr - Interface type data attributes
3641 *
3642 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3643 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag attribute
3644 *     for each interface type that supports the band data
3645 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC: HE MAC capabilities as in HE
3646 *     capabilities IE
3647 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY: HE PHY capabilities as in HE
3648 *     capabilities IE
3649 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET: HE supported NSS/MCS as in HE
3650 *     capabilities IE
3651 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE: HE PPE thresholds information as
3652 *     defined in HE capabilities IE
3653 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX: highest band HE capability attribute currently
3654 *     defined
3655 * @NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA: HE 6GHz band capabilities (__le16),
3656 *	given for all 6 GHz band channels
3657 * @__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3658 */
3659enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr {
3660	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_INVALID,
3661
3662	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_IFTYPES,
3663	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MAC,
3664	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PHY,
3665	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_MCS_SET,
3666	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_CAP_PPE,
3667	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_HE_6GHZ_CAPA,
3668
3669	/* keep last */
3670	__NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3671	NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_IFTYPE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3672};
3673
3674/**
3675 * enum nl80211_band_attr - band attributes
3676 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3677 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS: supported frequencies in this band,
3678 *	an array of nested frequency attributes
3679 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES: supported bitrates in this band,
3680 *	an array of nested bitrate attributes
3681 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET: 16-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3682 *	defined in 802.11n
3683 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA: HT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3684 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR: A-MPDU factor, as in 11n
3685 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY: A-MPDU density, as in 11n
3686 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET: 32-byte attribute containing the MCS set as
3687 *	defined in 802.11ac
3688 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA: VHT capabilities, as in the HT information IE
3689 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA: nested array attribute, with each entry using
3690 *	attributes from &enum nl80211_band_iftype_attr
3691 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz
3692 *	channel(s) that are allowed to be used for EDMG transmissions.
3693 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251.
3694 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
3695 *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations.
3696 *	Defined by IEEE P802.11ay/D4.0 section 9.4.2.251, Table 13.
3697 * @NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX: highest band attribute currently defined
3698 * @__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3699 */
3700enum nl80211_band_attr {
3701	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_INVALID,
3702	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_FREQS,
3703	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_RATES,
3704
3705	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_MCS_SET,
3706	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA,
3707	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_FACTOR,
3708	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_AMPDU_DENSITY,
3709
3710	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_MCS_SET,
3711	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_VHT_CAPA,
3712	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_IFTYPE_DATA,
3713
3714	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_CHANNELS,
3715	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_EDMG_BW_CONFIG,
3716
3717	/* keep last */
3718	__NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3719	NL80211_BAND_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BAND_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3720};
3721
3722#define NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA NL80211_BAND_ATTR_HT_CAPA
3723
3724/**
3725 * enum nl80211_wmm_rule - regulatory wmm rule
3726 *
3727 * @__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3728 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN: Minimum contention window slot.
3729 * @NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX: Maximum contention window slot.
3730 * @NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN: Arbitration Inter Frame Space.
3731 * @NL80211_WMMR_TXOP: Maximum allowed tx operation time.
3732 * @nl80211_WMMR_MAX: highest possible wmm rule.
3733 * @__NL80211_WMMR_LAST: Internal use.
3734 */
3735enum nl80211_wmm_rule {
3736	__NL80211_WMMR_INVALID,
3737	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MIN,
3738	NL80211_WMMR_CW_MAX,
3739	NL80211_WMMR_AIFSN,
3740	NL80211_WMMR_TXOP,
3741
3742	/* keep last */
3743	__NL80211_WMMR_LAST,
3744	NL80211_WMMR_MAX = __NL80211_WMMR_LAST - 1
3745};
3746
3747/**
3748 * enum nl80211_frequency_attr - frequency attributes
3749 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3750 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ: Frequency in MHz
3751 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED: Channel is disabled in current
3752 *	regulatory domain.
3753 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation
3754 * 	are permitted on this channel, this includes sending probe
3755 * 	requests, or modes of operation that require beaconing.
3756 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR: Radar detection is mandatory
3757 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3758 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER: Maximum transmission power in mBm
3759 *	(100 * dBm).
3760 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE: current state for DFS
3761 *	(enum nl80211_dfs_state)
3762 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME: time in miliseconds for how long
3763 *	this channel is in this DFS state.
3764 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS: HT40- isn't possible with this
3765 *	channel as the control channel
3766 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS: HT40+ isn't possible with this
3767 *	channel as the control channel
3768 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ: any 80 MHz channel using this channel
3769 *	as the primary or any of the secondary channels isn't possible,
3770 *	this includes 80+80 channels
3771 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ: any 160 MHz (but not 80+80) channel
3772 *	using this channel as the primary or any of the secondary channels
3773 *	isn't possible
3774 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3775 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY: Only indoor use is permitted on this
3776 *	channel. A channel that has the INDOOR_ONLY attribute can only be
3777 *	used when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating in
3778 *	an indoor surroundings, i.e., it is connected to AC power (and not
3779 *	through portable DC inverters) or is under the control of a master
3780 *	that is acting as an AP and is connected to AC power.
3781 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT: IR operation is allowed on this
3782 *	channel if it's connected concurrently to a BSS on the same channel on
3783 *	the 2 GHz band or to a channel in the same UNII band (on the 5 GHz
3784 *	band), and IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR is not set. Instantiating a GO or TDLS
3785 *	off-channel on a channel that has the IR_CONCURRENT attribute set can be
3786 *	done when there is a clear assessment that the device is operating under
3787 *	the guidance of an authorized master, i.e., setting up a GO or TDLS
3788 *	off-channel while the device is also connected to an AP with DFS and
3789 *	radar detection on the UNII band (it is up to user-space, i.e.,
3790 *	wpa_supplicant to perform the required verifications). Using this
3791 *	attribute for IR is disallowed for master interfaces (IBSS, AP).
3792 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz operation is not allowed
3793 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3794 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz operation is not allowed
3795 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3796 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM: this channel has wmm limitations.
3797 *	This is a nested attribute that contains the wmm limitation per AC.
3798 *	(see &enum nl80211_wmm_rule)
3799 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE: HE operation is not allowed on this channel
3800 *	in current regulatory domain.
3801 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
3802 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ: 1 MHz operation is allowed
3803 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3804 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ: 2 MHz operation is allowed
3805 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3806 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ: 4 MHz operation is allowed
3807 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3808 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ: 8 MHz operation is allowed
3809 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3810 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ: 16 MHz operation is allowed
3811 *	on this channel in current regulatory domain.
3812 * @NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX: highest frequency attribute number
3813 *	currently defined
3814 * @__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3815 *
3816 * See https://apps.fcc.gov/eas/comments/GetPublishedDocument.html?id=327&tn=528122
3817 * for more information on the FCC description of the relaxations allowed
3818 * by NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY and
3819 * NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT.
3820 */
3821enum nl80211_frequency_attr {
3822	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INVALID,
3823	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_FREQ,
3824	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DISABLED,
3825	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR,
3826	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS,
3827	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_RADAR,
3828	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER,
3829	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_STATE,
3830	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_TIME,
3831	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_MINUS,
3832	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HT40_PLUS,
3833	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_80MHZ,
3834	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_160MHZ,
3835	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3836	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY,
3837	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT,
3838	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_20MHZ,
3839	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_10MHZ,
3840	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_WMM,
3841	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_HE,
3842	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_OFFSET,
3843	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_1MHZ,
3844	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_2MHZ,
3845	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_4MHZ,
3846	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_8MHZ,
3847	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_16MHZ,
3848
3849	/* keep last */
3850	__NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3851	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3852};
3853
3854#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_MAX_TX_POWER
3855#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3856#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IBSS		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3857#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR		NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_NO_IR
3858#define NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_GO_CONCURRENT \
3859					NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
3860
3861/**
3862 * enum nl80211_bitrate_attr - bitrate attributes
3863 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3864 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE: Bitrate in units of 100 kbps
3865 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE: Short preamble supported
3866 *	in 2.4 GHz band.
3867 * @NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX: highest bitrate attribute number
3868 *	currently defined
3869 * @__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3870 */
3871enum nl80211_bitrate_attr {
3872	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_INVALID,
3873	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_RATE,
3874	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_2GHZ_SHORTPREAMBLE,
3875
3876	/* keep last */
3877	__NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3878	NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BITRATE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3879};
3880
3881/**
3882 * enum nl80211_initiator - Indicates the initiator of a reg domain request
3883 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE: Core queried CRDA for a dynamic world
3884 * 	regulatory domain.
3885 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER: User asked the wireless core to set the
3886 * 	regulatory domain.
3887 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER: a wireless drivers has hinted to the
3888 * 	wireless core it thinks its knows the regulatory domain we should be in.
3889 * @NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE: the wireless core has received an
3890 * 	802.11 country information element with regulatory information it
3891 * 	thinks we should consider. cfg80211 only processes the country
3892 *	code from the IE, and relies on the regulatory domain information
3893 *	structure passed by userspace (CRDA) from our wireless-regdb.
3894 *	If a channel is enabled but the country code indicates it should
3895 *	be disabled we disable the channel and re-enable it upon disassociation.
3896 */
3897enum nl80211_reg_initiator {
3898	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_CORE,
3899	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_USER,
3900	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER,
3901	NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_COUNTRY_IE,
3902};
3903
3904/**
3905 * enum nl80211_reg_type - specifies the type of regulatory domain
3906 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY: the regulatory domain set is one that pertains
3907 *	to a specific country. When this is set you can count on the
3908 *	ISO / IEC 3166 alpha2 country code being valid.
3909 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD: the regulatory set domain is the world regulatory
3910 * 	domain.
3911 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD: the regulatory domain set is a custom
3912 * 	driver specific world regulatory domain. These do not apply system-wide
3913 * 	and are only applicable to the individual devices which have requested
3914 * 	them to be applied.
3915 * @NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION: the regulatory domain set is the product
3916 *	of an intersection between two regulatory domains -- the previously
3917 *	set regulatory domain on the system and the last accepted regulatory
3918 *	domain request to be processed.
3919 */
3920enum nl80211_reg_type {
3921	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_COUNTRY,
3922	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_WORLD,
3923	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_CUSTOM_WORLD,
3924	NL80211_REGDOM_TYPE_INTERSECTION,
3925};
3926
3927/**
3928 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr - regulatory rule attributes
3929 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3930 * @NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS: a set of flags which specify additional
3931 * 	considerations for a given frequency range. These are the
3932 * 	&enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags.
3933 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START: starting frequencry for the regulatory
3934 * 	rule in KHz. This is not a center of frequency but an actual regulatory
3935 * 	band edge.
3936 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END: ending frequency for the regulatory rule
3937 * 	in KHz. This is not a center a frequency but an actual regulatory
3938 * 	band edge.
3939 * @NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW: maximum allowed bandwidth for this
3940 *	frequency range, in KHz.
3941 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN: the maximum allowed antenna gain
3942 * 	for a given frequency range. The value is in mBi (100 * dBi).
3943 * 	If you don't have one then don't send this.
3944 * @NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP: the maximum allowed EIRP for
3945 * 	a given frequency range. The value is in mBm (100 * dBm).
3946 * @NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME: DFS CAC time in milliseconds.
3947 *	If not present or 0 default CAC time will be used.
3948 * @NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX: highest regulatory rule attribute number
3949 *	currently defined
3950 * @__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
3951 */
3952enum nl80211_reg_rule_attr {
3953	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_INVALID,
3954	NL80211_ATTR_REG_RULE_FLAGS,
3955
3956	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_START,
3957	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_END,
3958	NL80211_ATTR_FREQ_RANGE_MAX_BW,
3959
3960	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_ANT_GAIN,
3961	NL80211_ATTR_POWER_RULE_MAX_EIRP,
3962
3963	NL80211_ATTR_DFS_CAC_TIME,
3964
3965	/* keep last */
3966	__NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
3967	NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_REG_RULE_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
3968};
3969
3970/**
3971 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr - scheduled scan match attributes
3972 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
3973 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID: SSID to be used for matching,
3974 *	only report BSS with matching SSID.
3975 *	(This cannot be used together with BSSID.)
3976 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI: RSSI threshold (in dBm) for reporting a
3977 *	BSS in scan results. Filtering is turned off if not specified. Note that
3978 *	if this attribute is in a match set of its own, then it is treated as
3979 *	the default value for all matchsets with an SSID, rather than being a
3980 *	matchset of its own without an RSSI filter. This is due to problems with
3981 *	how this API was implemented in the past. Also, due to the same problem,
3982 *	the only way to create a matchset with only an RSSI filter (with this
3983 *	attribute) is if there's only a single matchset with the RSSI attribute.
3984 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI: Flag indicating whether
3985 *	%NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI to be used as absolute RSSI or
3986 *	relative to current bss's RSSI.
3987 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
3988 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
3989 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
3990 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
3991 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID: BSSID to be used for matching
3992 *	(this cannot be used together with SSID).
3993 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI: Nested attribute that carries the
3994 *	band specific minimum rssi thresholds for the bands defined in
3995 *	enum nl80211_band. The minimum rssi threshold value(s32) specific to a
3996 *	band shall be encapsulated in attribute with type value equals to one
3997 *	of the NL80211_BAND_* defined in enum nl80211_band. For example, the
3998 *	minimum rssi threshold value for 2.4GHZ band shall be encapsulated
3999 *	within an attribute of type NL80211_BAND_2GHZ. And one or more of such
4000 *	attributes will be nested within this attribute.
4001 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest scheduled scan filter
4002 *	attribute number currently defined
4003 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4004 */
4005enum nl80211_sched_scan_match_attr {
4006	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_INVALID,
4007
4008	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID,
4009	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI,
4010	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RELATIVE_RSSI,
4011	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
4012	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_BSSID,
4013	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_PER_BAND_RSSI,
4014
4015	/* keep last */
4016	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4017	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX =
4018		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4019};
4020
4021/* only for backward compatibility */
4022#define NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_SSID NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_MATCH_ATTR_SSID
4023
4024/**
4025 * enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags - regulatory rule flags
4026 *
4027 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM: OFDM modulation not allowed
4028 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK: CCK modulation not allowed
4029 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR: indoor operation not allowed
4030 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR: outdoor operation not allowed
4031 * @NL80211_RRF_DFS: DFS support is required to be used
4032 * @NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Point links
4033 * @NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY: this is only for Point To Multi Point links
4034 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_IR: no mechanisms that initiate radiation are allowed,
4035 * 	this includes probe requests or modes of operation that require
4036 * 	beaconing.
4037 * @NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW: maximum available bandwidth should be calculated
4038 *	base on contiguous rules and wider channels will be allowed to cross
4039 *	multiple contiguous/overlapping frequency ranges.
4040 * @NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
4041 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS: channels can't be used in HT40- operation
4042 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS: channels can't be used in HT40+ operation
4043 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ: 80MHz operation not allowed
4044 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ: 160MHz operation not allowed
4045 * @NL80211_RRF_NO_HE: HE operation not allowed
4046 */
4047enum nl80211_reg_rule_flags {
4048	NL80211_RRF_NO_OFDM		= 1<<0,
4049	NL80211_RRF_NO_CCK		= 1<<1,
4050	NL80211_RRF_NO_INDOOR		= 1<<2,
4051	NL80211_RRF_NO_OUTDOOR		= 1<<3,
4052	NL80211_RRF_DFS			= 1<<4,
4053	NL80211_RRF_PTP_ONLY		= 1<<5,
4054	NL80211_RRF_PTMP_ONLY		= 1<<6,
4055	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		= 1<<7,
4056	__NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		= 1<<8,
4057	NL80211_RRF_AUTO_BW		= 1<<11,
4058	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<12,
4059	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<13,
4060	NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS		= 1<<14,
4061	NL80211_RRF_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<15,
4062	NL80211_RRF_NO_160MHZ		= 1<<16,
4063	NL80211_RRF_NO_HE		= 1<<17,
4064};
4065
4066#define NL80211_RRF_PASSIVE_SCAN	NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4067#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4068#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR		NL80211_RRF_NO_IR
4069#define NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40		(NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40MINUS |\
4070					 NL80211_RRF_NO_HT40PLUS)
4071#define NL80211_RRF_GO_CONCURRENT	NL80211_RRF_IR_CONCURRENT
4072
4073/* For backport compatibility with older userspace */
4074#define NL80211_RRF_NO_IR_ALL		(NL80211_RRF_NO_IR | __NL80211_RRF_NO_IBSS)
4075
4076/**
4077 * enum nl80211_dfs_regions - regulatory DFS regions
4078 *
4079 * @NL80211_DFS_UNSET: Country has no DFS master region specified
4080 * @NL80211_DFS_FCC: Country follows DFS master rules from FCC
4081 * @NL80211_DFS_ETSI: Country follows DFS master rules from ETSI
4082 * @NL80211_DFS_JP: Country follows DFS master rules from JP/MKK/Telec
4083 */
4084enum nl80211_dfs_regions {
4085	NL80211_DFS_UNSET	= 0,
4086	NL80211_DFS_FCC		= 1,
4087	NL80211_DFS_ETSI	= 2,
4088	NL80211_DFS_JP		= 3,
4089};
4090
4091/**
4092 * enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type - type of user regulatory hint
4093 *
4094 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER: a user sent the hint. This is always
4095 *	assumed if the attribute is not set.
4096 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE: the hint comes from a cellular
4097 *	base station. Device drivers that have been tested to work
4098 *	properly to support this type of hint can enable these hints
4099 *	by setting the NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS feature
4100 *	capability on the struct wiphy. The wireless core will
4101 *	ignore all cell base station hints until at least one device
4102 *	present has been registered with the wireless core that
4103 *	has listed NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS as a
4104 *	supported feature.
4105 * @NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR: a user sent an hint indicating that the
4106 *	platform is operating in an indoor environment.
4107 */
4108enum nl80211_user_reg_hint_type {
4109	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_USER	= 0,
4110	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_CELL_BASE = 1,
4111	NL80211_USER_REG_HINT_INDOOR    = 2,
4112};
4113
4114/**
4115 * enum nl80211_survey_info - survey information
4116 *
4117 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_SURVEY_INFO
4118 * when getting information about a survey.
4119 *
4120 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
4121 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY: center frequency of channel
4122 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE: noise level of channel (u8, dBm)
4123 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
4124 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME: amount of time (in ms) that the radio
4125 *	was turned on (on channel or globally)
4126 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: amount of the time the primary
4127 *	channel was sensed busy (either due to activity or energy detect)
4128 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: amount of time the extension
4129 *	channel was sensed busy
4130 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4131 *	receiving data (on channel or globally)
4132 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: amount of time the radio spent
4133 *	transmitting data (on channel or globally)
4134 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: time the radio spent for scan
4135 *	(on this channel or globally)
4136 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4137 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: amount of time the radio spent
4138 *	receiving frames destined to the local BSS
4139 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX: highest survey info attribute number
4140 *	currently defined
4141 * @NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: center frequency offset in KHz
4142 * @__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4143 */
4144enum nl80211_survey_info {
4145	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_INVALID,
4146	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY,
4147	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_NOISE,
4148	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE,
4149	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME,
4150	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY,
4151	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY,
4152	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX,
4153	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX,
4154	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN,
4155	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_PAD,
4156	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX,
4157	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4158
4159	/* keep last */
4160	__NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST,
4161	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_MAX = __NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_AFTER_LAST - 1
4162};
4163
4164/* keep old names for compatibility */
4165#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME
4166#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_BUSY		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY
4167#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_EXT_BUSY	NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY
4168#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_RX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX
4169#define NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_CHANNEL_TIME_TX		NL80211_SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX
4170
4171/**
4172 * enum nl80211_mntr_flags - monitor configuration flags
4173 *
4174 * Monitor configuration flags.
4175 *
4176 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID: reserved
4177 *
4178 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
4179 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
4180 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
4181 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
4182 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing.
4183 *	overrides all other flags.
4184 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE: use the configured MAC address
4185 *	and ACK incoming unicast packets.
4186 *
4187 * @__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4188 * @NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX: highest possible monitor flag
4189 */
4190enum nl80211_mntr_flags {
4191	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
4192	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
4193	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
4194	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
4195	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
4196	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
4197	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
4198
4199	/* keep last */
4200	__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST,
4201	NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_MAX = __NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_AFTER_LAST - 1
4202};
4203
4204/**
4205 * enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode - mesh power save modes
4206 *
4207 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN: The mesh power mode of the mesh STA is
4208 *	not known or has not been set yet.
4209 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE: Active mesh power mode. The mesh STA is
4210 *	in Awake state all the time.
4211 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP: Light sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4212 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but will wake up for
4213 *	neighbor's beacons.
4214 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP: Deep sleep mode. The mesh STA will
4215 *	alternate between Active and Doze states, but may not wake up
4216 *	for neighbor's beacons.
4217 *
4218 * @__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - internal use
4219 * @NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX - highest possible power save level
4220 */
4221
4222enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode {
4223	NL80211_MESH_POWER_UNKNOWN,
4224	NL80211_MESH_POWER_ACTIVE,
4225	NL80211_MESH_POWER_LIGHT_SLEEP,
4226	NL80211_MESH_POWER_DEEP_SLEEP,
4227
4228	__NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST,
4229	NL80211_MESH_POWER_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_POWER_AFTER_LAST - 1
4230};
4231
4232/**
4233 * enum nl80211_meshconf_params - mesh configuration parameters
4234 *
4235 * Mesh configuration parameters. These can be changed while the mesh is
4236 * active.
4237 *
4238 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID: internal use
4239 *
4240 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial retry timeout in
4241 *	millisecond units, used by the Peer Link Open message
4242 *
4243 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT: specifies the initial confirm timeout, in
4244 *	millisecond units, used by the peer link management to close a peer link
4245 *
4246 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT: specifies the holding timeout, in
4247 *	millisecond units
4248 *
4249 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS: maximum number of peer links allowed
4250 *	on this mesh interface
4251 *
4252 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES: specifies the maximum number of peer link
4253 *	open retries that can be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a
4254 *	mesh
4255 *
4256 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a source mesh
4257 *	point.
4258 *
4259 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS: whether we should automatically open
4260 *	peer links when we detect compatible mesh peers. Disabled if
4261 *	@NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM or @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE are
4262 *	set.
4263 *
4264 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES: the number of action frames
4265 *	containing a PREQ that an MP can send to a particular destination (path
4266 *	target)
4267 *
4268 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME: how frequently to refresh mesh paths
4269 *	(in milliseconds)
4270 *
4271 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: minimum length of time to wait
4272 *	until giving up on a path discovery (in milliseconds)
4273 *
4274 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for which mesh
4275 *	points receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from
4276 *	the root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
4277 *
4278 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4279 *	TUs) during which an MP can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
4280 *	reference element
4281 *
4282 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME: The interval of time (in TUs)
4283 *	that it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the
4284 *	mesh
4285 *
4286 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE: whether root mode is enabled or not
4287 *
4288 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL: specifies the value of TTL field set at a
4289 *	source mesh point for path selection elements.
4290 *
4291 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL:  The interval of time (in TUs) between
4292 *	root announcements are transmitted.
4293 *
4294 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS: Advertise that this mesh station has
4295 *	access to a broader network beyond the MBSS.  This is done via Root
4296 *	Announcement frames.
4297 *
4298 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time (in
4299 *	TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a
4300 *	PERR element.
4301 *
4302 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING: set Mesh STA as forwarding or non-forwarding
4303 *	or forwarding entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
4304 *
4305 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This specifies the
4306 *	threshold for average signal strength of candidate station to establish
4307 *	a peer link.
4308 *
4309 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR: maximum number of neighbors
4310 *	to synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
4311 *	(see 11C.12.2.2)
4312 *
4313 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE: set mesh HT protection mode.
4314 *
4315 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh configuration attribute
4316 *
4317 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT: The time (in TUs) for
4318 *	which mesh STAs receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding
4319 *	information to the root mesh STA to be valid.
4320 *
4321 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL: The interval of time (in TUs) between
4322 *	proactive PREQs are transmitted.
4323 *
4324 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL: The minimum interval of time
4325 *	(in TUs) during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame
4326 *	containing a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
4327 *
4328 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE: Default mesh power mode for new peer links.
4329 *	type &enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode (u32)
4330 *
4331 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW: awake window duration (in TUs)
4332 *
4333 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've
4334 *	established peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then
4335 *	remove it from the STA's list of peers. You may set this to 0 to disable
4336 *	the removal of the STA. Default is 30 minutes.
4337 *
4338 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE: If set to true then this mesh STA
4339 *	will advertise that it is connected to a gate in the mesh formation
4340 *	field.  If left unset then the mesh formation field will only
4341 *	advertise such if there is an active root mesh path.
4342 *
4343 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g.
4344 *      PREQ/PREP for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that
4345 *      this might not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be
4346 *      better. So if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
4347 *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
4348 *
4349 * @NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS: If set to true then this mesh STA
4350 *	will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
4351 *	in the mesh formation field.
4352 *
4353 * @__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use
4354 */
4355enum nl80211_meshconf_params {
4356	__NL80211_MESHCONF_INVALID,
4357	NL80211_MESHCONF_RETRY_TIMEOUT,
4358	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONFIRM_TIMEOUT,
4359	NL80211_MESHCONF_HOLDING_TIMEOUT,
4360	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_PEER_LINKS,
4361	NL80211_MESHCONF_MAX_RETRIES,
4362	NL80211_MESHCONF_TTL,
4363	NL80211_MESHCONF_AUTO_OPEN_PLINKS,
4364	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_MAX_PREQ_RETRIES,
4365	NL80211_MESHCONF_PATH_REFRESH_TIME,
4366	NL80211_MESHCONF_MIN_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT,
4367	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ACTIVE_PATH_TIMEOUT,
4368	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PREQ_MIN_INTERVAL,
4369	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_NET_DIAM_TRVS_TIME,
4370	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOTMODE,
4371	NL80211_MESHCONF_ELEMENT_TTL,
4372	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_RANN_INTERVAL,
4373	NL80211_MESHCONF_GATE_ANNOUNCEMENTS,
4374	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PERR_MIN_INTERVAL,
4375	NL80211_MESHCONF_FORWARDING,
4376	NL80211_MESHCONF_RSSI_THRESHOLD,
4377	NL80211_MESHCONF_SYNC_OFFSET_MAX_NEIGHBOR,
4378	NL80211_MESHCONF_HT_OPMODE,
4379	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_PATH_TO_ROOT_TIMEOUT,
4380	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_ROOT_INTERVAL,
4381	NL80211_MESHCONF_HWMP_CONFIRMATION_INTERVAL,
4382	NL80211_MESHCONF_POWER_MODE,
4383	NL80211_MESHCONF_AWAKE_WINDOW,
4384	NL80211_MESHCONF_PLINK_TIMEOUT,
4385	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_GATE,
4386	NL80211_MESHCONF_NOLEARN,
4387	NL80211_MESHCONF_CONNECTED_TO_AS,
4388
4389	/* keep last */
4390	__NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4391	NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESHCONF_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4392};
4393
4394/**
4395 * enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params - mesh setup parameters
4396 *
4397 * Mesh setup parameters.  These are used to start/join a mesh and cannot be
4398 * changed while the mesh is active.
4399 *
4400 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID: Internal use
4401 *
4402 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL: Enable this option to use a
4403 *	vendor specific path selection algorithm or disable it to use the
4404 *	default HWMP.
4405 *
4406 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC: Enable this option to use a
4407 *	vendor specific path metric or disable it to use the default Airtime
4408 *	metric.
4409 *
4410 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE: Information elements for this mesh, for instance, a
4411 *	robust security network ie, or a vendor specific information element
4412 *	that vendors will use to identify the path selection methods and
4413 *	metrics in use.
4414 *
4415 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH: Enable this option if an authentication
4416 *	daemon will be authenticating mesh candidates.
4417 *
4418 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE: Enable this option if an authentication
4419 *	daemon will be securing peer link frames.  AMPE is a secured version of
4420 *	Mesh Peering Management (MPM) and is implemented with the assistance of
4421 *	a userspace daemon.  When this flag is set, the kernel will send peer
4422 *	management frames to a userspace daemon that will implement AMPE
4423 *	functionality (security capabilities selection, key confirmation, and
4424 *	key management).  When the flag is unset (default), the kernel can
4425 *	autonomously complete (unsecured) mesh peering without the need of a
4426 *	userspace daemon.
4427 *
4428 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC: Enable this option to use a
4429 *	vendor specific synchronization method or disable it to use the default
4430 *	neighbor offset synchronization
4431 *
4432 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM: Enable this option if userspace will
4433 *	implement an MPM which handles peer allocation and state.
4434 *
4435 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL: Inform the kernel of the authentication
4436 *	method (u8, as defined in IEEE 8.4.2.100.6, e.g. 0x1 for SAE).
4437 *	Default is no authentication method required.
4438 *
4439 * @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX: highest possible mesh setup attribute number
4440 *
4441 * @__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal use
4442 */
4443enum nl80211_mesh_setup_params {
4444	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_INVALID,
4445	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_PATH_SEL,
4446	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_METRIC,
4447	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_IE,
4448	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH,
4449	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AMPE,
4450	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ENABLE_VENDOR_SYNC,
4451	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_MPM,
4452	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_AUTH_PROTOCOL,
4453
4454	/* keep last */
4455	__NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4456	NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_MESH_SETUP_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4457};
4458
4459/**
4460 * enum nl80211_txq_attr - TX queue parameter attributes
4461 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID: Attribute number 0 is reserved
4462 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC: AC identifier (NL80211_AC_*)
4463 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning
4464 *	disabled
4465 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN: Minimum contention window [a value of the form
4466 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4467 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX: Maximum contention window [a value of the form
4468 *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
4469 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
4470 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
4471 * @NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX: Maximum TXQ attribute number
4472 */
4473enum nl80211_txq_attr {
4474	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_INVALID,
4475	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC,
4476	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_TXOP,
4477	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMIN,
4478	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_CWMAX,
4479	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AIFS,
4480
4481	/* keep last */
4482	__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
4483	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
4484};
4485
4486enum nl80211_ac {
4487	NL80211_AC_VO,
4488	NL80211_AC_VI,
4489	NL80211_AC_BE,
4490	NL80211_AC_BK,
4491	NL80211_NUM_ACS
4492};
4493
4494/* backward compat */
4495#define NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_QUEUE	NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AC
4496#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VO	NL80211_AC_VO
4497#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_VI	NL80211_AC_VI
4498#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BE	NL80211_AC_BE
4499#define NL80211_TXQ_Q_BK	NL80211_AC_BK
4500
4501/**
4502 * enum nl80211_channel_type - channel type
4503 * @NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4504 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT20: 20 MHz HT channel
4505 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4506 *	below the control channel
4507 * @NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS: HT40 channel, secondary channel
4508 *	above the control channel
4509 */
4510enum nl80211_channel_type {
4511	NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT,
4512	NL80211_CHAN_HT20,
4513	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS,
4514	NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS
4515};
4516
4517/**
4518 * enum nl80211_key_mode - Key mode
4519 *
4520 * @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX: (Default)
4521 *	Key can be used for Rx and Tx immediately
4522 *
4523 * The following modes can only be selected for unicast keys and when the
4524 * driver supports @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID:
4525 *
4526 * @NL80211_KEY_NO_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_NEW_KEY:
4527 *	Unicast key can only be used for Rx, Tx not allowed, yet
4528 * @NL80211_KEY_SET_TX: Only allowed in combination with @NL80211_CMD_SET_KEY:
4529 *	The unicast key identified by idx and mac is cleared for Tx and becomes
4530 *	the preferred Tx key for the station.
4531 */
4532enum nl80211_key_mode {
4533	NL80211_KEY_RX_TX,
4534	NL80211_KEY_NO_TX,
4535	NL80211_KEY_SET_TX
4536};
4537
4538/**
4539 * enum nl80211_chan_width - channel width definitions
4540 *
4541 * These values are used with the %NL80211_ATTR_CHANNEL_WIDTH
4542 * attribute.
4543 *
4544 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 20 MHz, non-HT channel
4545 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 20 MHz HT channel
4546 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 40 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4547 *	attribute must be provided as well
4548 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80: 80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4549 *	attribute must be provided as well
4550 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80: 80+80 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4551 *	and %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ2 attributes must be provided as well
4552 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160: 160 MHz channel, the %NL80211_ATTR_CENTER_FREQ1
4553 *	attribute must be provided as well
4554 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 5 MHz OFDM channel
4555 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 10 MHz OFDM channel
4556 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1: 1 MHz OFDM channel
4557 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2: 2 MHz OFDM channel
4558 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4: 4 MHz OFDM channel
4559 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8: 8 MHz OFDM channel
4560 * @NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16: 16 MHz OFDM channel
4561 */
4562enum nl80211_chan_width {
4563	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT,
4564	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4565	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40,
4566	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80,
4567	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80,
4568	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160,
4569	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4570	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4571	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4572	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4573	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_4,
4574	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_8,
4575	NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_16,
4576};
4577
4578/**
4579 * enum nl80211_bss_scan_width - control channel width for a BSS
4580 *
4581 * These values are used with the %NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH attribute.
4582 *
4583 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20: control channel is 20 MHz wide or compatible
4584 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10: control channel is 10 MHz wide
4585 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5: control channel is 5 MHz wide
4586 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1: control channel is 1 MHz wide
4587 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2: control channel is 2 MHz wide
4588 */
4589enum nl80211_bss_scan_width {
4590	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
4591	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10,
4592	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5,
4593	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_1,
4594	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_2,
4595};
4596
4597/**
4598 * enum nl80211_bss - netlink attributes for a BSS
4599 *
4600 * @__NL80211_BSS_INVALID: invalid
4601 * @NL80211_BSS_BSSID: BSSID of the BSS (6 octets)
4602 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY: frequency in MHz (u32)
4603 * @NL80211_BSS_TSF: TSF of the received probe response/beacon (u64)
4604 *	(if @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA is present then this is known to be
4605 *	from a probe response, otherwise it may be from the same beacon
4606 *	that the NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF will be from)
4607 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL: beacon interval of the (I)BSS (u16)
4608 * @NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY: capability field (CPU order, u16)
4609 * @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS: binary attribute containing the
4610 *	raw information elements from the probe response/beacon (bin);
4611 *	if the %NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES attribute is present and the data is
4612 *	different then the IEs here are from a Probe Response frame; otherwise
4613 *	they are from a Beacon frame.
4614 *	However, if the driver does not indicate the source of the IEs, these
4615 *	IEs may be from either frame subtype.
4616 *	If present, the @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA attribute indicates that the
4617 *	data here is known to be from a probe response, without any heuristics.
4618 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM: signal strength of probe response/beacon
4619 *	in mBm (100 * dBm) (s32)
4620 * @NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC: signal strength of the probe response/beacon
4621 *	in unspecified units, scaled to 0..100 (u8)
4622 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS: status, if this BSS is "used"
4623 * @NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO: age of this BSS entry in ms
4624 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES: binary attribute containing the raw information
4625 *	elements from a Beacon frame (bin); not present if no Beacon frame has
4626 *	yet been received
4627 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH: channel width of the control channel
4628 *	(u32, enum nl80211_bss_scan_width)
4629 * @NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF: TSF of the last received beacon (u64)
4630 *	(not present if no beacon frame has been received yet)
4631 * @NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA: the data in @NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS and
4632 *	@NL80211_BSS_TSF is known to be from a probe response (flag attribute)
4633 * @NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp when this entry
4634 *	was last updated by a received frame. The value is expected to be
4635 *	accurate to about 10ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
4636 * @NL80211_BSS_PAD: attribute used for padding for 64-bit alignment
4637 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF: the time at the start of reception of the first
4638 *	octet of the timestamp field of the last beacon/probe received for
4639 *	this BSS. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified by
4640 *	@NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID. (u64).
4641 * @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID: the BSS according to which @NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF
4642 *	is set.
4643 * @NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL: per-chain signal strength of last BSS update.
4644 *	Contains a nested array of signal strength attributes (u8, dBm),
4645 *	using the nesting index as the antenna number.
4646 * @NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET: frequency offset in KHz
4647 * @__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST: internal
4648 * @NL80211_BSS_MAX: highest BSS attribute
4649 */
4650enum nl80211_bss {
4651	__NL80211_BSS_INVALID,
4652	NL80211_BSS_BSSID,
4653	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY,
4654	NL80211_BSS_TSF,
4655	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_INTERVAL,
4656	NL80211_BSS_CAPABILITY,
4657	NL80211_BSS_INFORMATION_ELEMENTS,
4658	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_MBM,
4659	NL80211_BSS_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
4660	NL80211_BSS_STATUS,
4661	NL80211_BSS_SEEN_MS_AGO,
4662	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_IES,
4663	NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH,
4664	NL80211_BSS_BEACON_TSF,
4665	NL80211_BSS_PRESP_DATA,
4666	NL80211_BSS_LAST_SEEN_BOOTTIME,
4667	NL80211_BSS_PAD,
4668	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
4669	NL80211_BSS_PARENT_BSSID,
4670	NL80211_BSS_CHAIN_SIGNAL,
4671	NL80211_BSS_FREQUENCY_OFFSET,
4672
4673	/* keep last */
4674	__NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST,
4675	NL80211_BSS_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_AFTER_LAST - 1
4676};
4677
4678/**
4679 * enum nl80211_bss_status - BSS "status"
4680 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED: Authenticated with this BSS.
4681 *	Note that this is no longer used since cfg80211 no longer
4682 *	keeps track of whether or not authentication was done with
4683 *	a given BSS.
4684 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED: Associated with this BSS.
4685 * @NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED: Joined to this IBSS.
4686 *
4687 * The BSS status is a BSS attribute in scan dumps, which
4688 * indicates the status the interface has wrt. this BSS.
4689 */
4690enum nl80211_bss_status {
4691	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_AUTHENTICATED,
4692	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_ASSOCIATED,
4693	NL80211_BSS_STATUS_IBSS_JOINED,
4694};
4695
4696/**
4697 * enum nl80211_auth_type - AuthenticationType
4698 *
4699 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM: Open System authentication
4700 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY: Shared Key authentication (WEP only)
4701 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT: Fast BSS Transition (IEEE 802.11r)
4702 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP: Network EAP (some Cisco APs and mainly LEAP)
4703 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE: Simultaneous authentication of equals
4704 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key
4705 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS: Fast Initial Link Setup shared key with PFS
4706 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK: Fast Initial Link Setup public key
4707 * @__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM: internal
4708 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX: maximum valid auth algorithm
4709 * @NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC: determine automatically (if necessary by
4710 *	trying multiple times); this is invalid in netlink -- leave out
4711 *	the attribute for this on CONNECT commands.
4712 */
4713enum nl80211_auth_type {
4714	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_OPEN_SYSTEM,
4715	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SHARED_KEY,
4716	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FT,
4717	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NETWORK_EAP,
4718	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_SAE,
4719	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK,
4720	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_SK_PFS,
4721	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_FILS_PK,
4722
4723	/* keep last */
4724	__NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM,
4725	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_MAX = __NL80211_AUTHTYPE_NUM - 1,
4726	NL80211_AUTHTYPE_AUTOMATIC
4727};
4728
4729/**
4730 * enum nl80211_key_type - Key Type
4731 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP: Group (broadcast/multicast) key
4732 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE: Pairwise (unicast/individual) key
4733 * @NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY: PeerKey (DLS)
4734 * @NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES: number of defined key types
4735 */
4736enum nl80211_key_type {
4737	NL80211_KEYTYPE_GROUP,
4738	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PAIRWISE,
4739	NL80211_KEYTYPE_PEERKEY,
4740
4741	NUM_NL80211_KEYTYPES
4742};
4743
4744/**
4745 * enum nl80211_mfp - Management frame protection state
4746 * @NL80211_MFP_NO: Management frame protection not used
4747 * @NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED: Management frame protection required
4748 * @NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL: Management frame protection is optional
4749 */
4750enum nl80211_mfp {
4751	NL80211_MFP_NO,
4752	NL80211_MFP_REQUIRED,
4753	NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL,
4754};
4755
4756enum nl80211_wpa_versions {
4757	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_1 = 1 << 0,
4758	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_2 = 1 << 1,
4759	NL80211_WPA_VERSION_3 = 1 << 2,
4760};
4761
4762/**
4763 * enum nl80211_key_default_types - key default types
4764 * @__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID: invalid
4765 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST: key should be used as default
4766 *	unicast key
4767 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST: key should be used as default
4768 *	multicast key
4769 * @NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: number of default types
4770 */
4771enum nl80211_key_default_types {
4772	__NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_INVALID,
4773	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_UNICAST,
4774	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPE_MULTICAST,
4775
4776	NUM_NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES
4777};
4778
4779/**
4780 * enum nl80211_key_attributes - key attributes
4781 * @__NL80211_KEY_INVALID: invalid
4782 * @NL80211_KEY_DATA: (temporal) key data; for TKIP this consists of
4783 *	16 bytes encryption key followed by 8 bytes each for TX and RX MIC
4784 *	keys
4785 * @NL80211_KEY_IDX: key ID (u8, 0-3)
4786 * @NL80211_KEY_CIPHER: key cipher suite (u32, as defined by IEEE 802.11
4787 *	section 7.3.2.25.1, e.g. 0x000FAC04)
4788 * @NL80211_KEY_SEQ: transmit key sequence number (IV/PN) for TKIP and
4789 *	CCMP keys, each six bytes in little endian
4790 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT: flag indicating default key
4791 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT: flag indicating default management key
4792 * @NL80211_KEY_TYPE: the key type from enum nl80211_key_type, if not
4793 *	specified the default depends on whether a MAC address was
4794 *	given with the command using the key or not (u32)
4795 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES: A nested attribute containing flags
4796 *	attributes, specifying what a key should be set as default as.
4797 *	See &enum nl80211_key_default_types.
4798 * @NL80211_KEY_MODE: the mode from enum nl80211_key_mode.
4799 *	Defaults to @NL80211_KEY_RX_TX.
4800 * @NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON: flag indicating default Beacon frame key
4801 *
4802 * @__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST: internal
4803 * @NL80211_KEY_MAX: highest key attribute
4804 */
4805enum nl80211_key_attributes {
4806	__NL80211_KEY_INVALID,
4807	NL80211_KEY_DATA,
4808	NL80211_KEY_IDX,
4809	NL80211_KEY_CIPHER,
4810	NL80211_KEY_SEQ,
4811	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT,
4812	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_MGMT,
4813	NL80211_KEY_TYPE,
4814	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_TYPES,
4815	NL80211_KEY_MODE,
4816	NL80211_KEY_DEFAULT_BEACON,
4817
4818	/* keep last */
4819	__NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST,
4820	NL80211_KEY_MAX = __NL80211_KEY_AFTER_LAST - 1
4821};
4822
4823/**
4824 * enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes - TX rate set attributes
4825 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID: invalid
4826 * @NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY: Legacy (non-MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4827 *	in an array of rates as defined in IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.2 (u8 values with
4828 *	1 = 500 kbps) but without the IE length restriction (at most
4829 *	%NL80211_MAX_SUPP_RATES in a single array).
4830 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HT: HT (MCS) rates allowed for TX rate selection
4831 *	in an array of MCS numbers.
4832 * @NL80211_TXRATE_VHT: VHT rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4833 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_vht
4834 * @NL80211_TXRATE_GI: configure GI, see &enum nl80211_txrate_gi
4835 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE: HE rates allowed for TX rate selection,
4836 *	see &struct nl80211_txrate_he
4837 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI: configure HE GI, 0.8us, 1.6us and 3.2us.
4838 * @NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF: configure HE LTF, 1XLTF, 2XLTF and 4XLTF.
4839 * @__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST: internal
4840 * @NL80211_TXRATE_MAX: highest TX rate attribute
4841 */
4842enum nl80211_tx_rate_attributes {
4843	__NL80211_TXRATE_INVALID,
4844	NL80211_TXRATE_LEGACY,
4845	NL80211_TXRATE_HT,
4846	NL80211_TXRATE_VHT,
4847	NL80211_TXRATE_GI,
4848	NL80211_TXRATE_HE,
4849	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_GI,
4850	NL80211_TXRATE_HE_LTF,
4851
4852	/* keep last */
4853	__NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST,
4854	NL80211_TXRATE_MAX = __NL80211_TXRATE_AFTER_LAST - 1
4855};
4856
4857#define NL80211_TXRATE_MCS NL80211_TXRATE_HT
4858#define NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX		8
4859
4860/**
4861 * struct nl80211_txrate_vht - VHT MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4862 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4863 */
4864struct nl80211_txrate_vht {
4865	__u16 mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
4866};
4867
4868#define NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX		8
4869/**
4870 * struct nl80211_txrate_he - HE MCS/NSS txrate bitmap
4871 * @mcs: MCS bitmap table for each NSS (array index 0 for 1 stream, etc.)
4872 */
4873struct nl80211_txrate_he {
4874	__u16 mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
4875};
4876
4877enum nl80211_txrate_gi {
4878	NL80211_TXRATE_DEFAULT_GI,
4879	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_SGI,
4880	NL80211_TXRATE_FORCE_LGI,
4881};
4882
4883/**
4884 * enum nl80211_band - Frequency band
4885 * @NL80211_BAND_2GHZ: 2.4 GHz ISM band
4886 * @NL80211_BAND_5GHZ: around 5 GHz band (4.9 - 5.7 GHz)
4887 * @NL80211_BAND_60GHZ: around 60 GHz band (58.32 - 69.12 GHz)
4888 * @NL80211_BAND_6GHZ: around 6 GHz band (5.9 - 7.2 GHz)
4889 * @NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ: around 900MHz, supported by S1G PHYs
4890 * @NUM_NL80211_BANDS: number of bands, avoid using this in userspace
4891 *	since newer kernel versions may support more bands
4892 */
4893enum nl80211_band {
4894	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ,
4895	NL80211_BAND_5GHZ,
4896	NL80211_BAND_60GHZ,
4897	NL80211_BAND_6GHZ,
4898	NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ,
4899
4900	NUM_NL80211_BANDS,
4901};
4902
4903/**
4904 * enum nl80211_ps_state - powersave state
4905 * @NL80211_PS_DISABLED: powersave is disabled
4906 * @NL80211_PS_ENABLED: powersave is enabled
4907 */
4908enum nl80211_ps_state {
4909	NL80211_PS_DISABLED,
4910	NL80211_PS_ENABLED,
4911};
4912
4913/**
4914 * enum nl80211_attr_cqm - connection quality monitor attributes
4915 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID: invalid
4916 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD: RSSI threshold in dBm. This value specifies
4917 *	the threshold for the RSSI level at which an event will be sent. Zero
4918 *	to disable.  Alternatively, if %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST is
4919 *	set, multiple values can be supplied as a low-to-high sorted array of
4920 *	threshold values in dBm.  Events will be sent when the RSSI value
4921 *	crosses any of the thresholds.
4922 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST: RSSI hysteresis in dBm. This value specifies
4923 *	the minimum amount the RSSI level must change after an event before a
4924 *	new event may be issued (to reduce effects of RSSI oscillation).
4925 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT: RSSI threshold event
4926 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT: a u32 value indicating that this many
4927 *	consecutive packets were not acknowledged by the peer
4928 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE: TX error rate in %. Minimum % of TX failures
4929 *	during the given %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before an
4930 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM with reported %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE and
4931 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS is generated.
4932 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS: number of attempted packets in a given
4933 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL before %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE is
4934 *	checked.
4935 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL: interval in seconds. Specifies the periodic
4936 *	interval in which %NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS and
4937 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE must be satisfied before generating an
4938 *	%NL80211_CMD_NOTIFY_CQM. Set to 0 to turn off TX error reporting.
4939 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: flag attribute that's set in a beacon
4940 *	loss event
4941 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL: the RSSI value in dBm that triggered the
4942 *	RSSI threshold event.
4943 * @__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST: internal
4944 * @NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX: highest key attribute
4945 */
4946enum nl80211_attr_cqm {
4947	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_INVALID,
4948	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD,
4949	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_HYST,
4950	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT,
4951	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_PKT_LOSS_EVENT,
4952	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_RATE,
4953	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_PKTS,
4954	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_TXE_INTVL,
4955	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4956	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_LEVEL,
4957
4958	/* keep last */
4959	__NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST,
4960	NL80211_ATTR_CQM_MAX = __NL80211_ATTR_CQM_AFTER_LAST - 1
4961};
4962
4963/**
4964 * enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event - RSSI threshold event
4965 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW: The RSSI level is lower than the
4966 *      configured threshold
4967 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH: The RSSI is higher than the
4968 *      configured threshold
4969 * @NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT: (reserved, never sent)
4970 */
4971enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event {
4972	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_LOW,
4973	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_THRESHOLD_EVENT_HIGH,
4974	NL80211_CQM_RSSI_BEACON_LOSS_EVENT,
4975};
4976
4977
4978/**
4979 * enum nl80211_tx_power_setting - TX power adjustment
4980 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine transmit power
4981 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED: limit TX power by the mBm parameter
4982 * @NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED: fix TX power to the mBm parameter
4983 */
4984enum nl80211_tx_power_setting {
4985	NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC,
4986	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED,
4987	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED,
4988};
4989
4990/**
4991 * enum nl80211_tid_config - TID config state
4992 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE: Enable config for the TID
4993 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE: Disable config for the TID
4994 */
4995enum nl80211_tid_config {
4996	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ENABLE,
4997	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_DISABLE,
4998};
4999
5000/* enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting - TX rate configuration type
5001 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC: automatically determine TX rate
5002 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED: limit the TX rate by the TX rate parameter
5003 * @NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED: fix TX rate to the TX rate parameter
5004 */
5005enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting {
5006	NL80211_TX_RATE_AUTOMATIC,
5007	NL80211_TX_RATE_LIMITED,
5008	NL80211_TX_RATE_FIXED,
5009};
5010
5011/* enum nl80211_tid_config_attr - TID specific configuration.
5012 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD: pad attribute for 64-bit values
5013 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP: a bitmap (u64) of attributes supported
5014 *	for per-vif configuration; doesn't list the ones that are generic
5015 *	(%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS, %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE).
5016 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP: same as the previous per-vif one, but
5017 *	per peer instead.
5018 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE: flag attribue, if set indicates
5019 *	that the new configuration overrides all previous peer
5020 *	configurations, otherwise previous peer specific configurations
5021 *	should be left untouched.
5022 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS: a bitmask value of TIDs (bit 0 to 7)
5023 *	Its type is u16.
5024 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK: Configure ack policy for the TID.
5025 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TID. see %enum nl80211_tid_config.
5026 *	Its type is u8.
5027 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT: Number of retries used with data frame
5028 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5029 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. It is u8 type, min value is 1 and
5030 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5031 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5032 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG: Number of retries used with data frame
5033 *	transmission, user-space sets this configuration in
5034 *	&NL80211_CMD_SET_TID_CONFIG. Its type is u8, min value is 1 and
5035 *	the max value is advertised by the driver in this attribute on
5036 *	output in wiphy capabilities.
5037 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
5038 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5039 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5040 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL: Enable/Disable RTS_CTS for the TIDs
5041 *	specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. It is u8 type, using
5042 *	the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5043 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
5044 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS.
5045 *	Its type is u8, using the values from &nl80211_tid_config.
5046 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE: This attribute will be useful
5047 *	to notfiy the driver that what type of txrate should be used
5048 *	for the TIDs specified in %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS. using
5049 *	the values form &nl80211_tx_rate_setting.
5050 * @NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE: Data frame TX rate mask should be applied
5051 *	with the parameters passed through %NL80211_ATTR_TX_RATES.
5052 *	configuration is applied to the data frame for the tid to that connected
5053 *	station.
5054 */
5055enum nl80211_tid_config_attr {
5056	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_INVALID,
5057	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PAD,
5058	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_VIF_SUPP,
5059	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_PEER_SUPP,
5060	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_OVERRIDE,
5061	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TIDS,
5062	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_NOACK,
5063	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT,
5064	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG,
5065	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMPDU_CTRL,
5066	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RTSCTS_CTRL,
5067	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AMSDU_CTRL,
5068	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE_TYPE,
5069	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_TX_RATE,
5070
5071	/* keep last */
5072	__NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
5073	NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
5074};
5075
5076/**
5077 * enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr - packet pattern attribute
5078 * @__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5079 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN: the pattern, values where the mask has
5080 *	a zero bit are ignored
5081 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK: pattern mask, must be long enough to have
5082 *	a bit for each byte in the pattern. The lowest-order bit corresponds
5083 *	to the first byte of the pattern, but the bytes of the pattern are
5084 *	in a little-endian-like format, i.e. the 9th byte of the pattern
5085 *	corresponds to the lowest-order bit in the second byte of the mask.
5086 *	For example: The match 00:xx:00:00:xx:00:00:00:00:xx:xx:xx (where
5087 *	xx indicates "don't care") would be represented by a pattern of
5088 *	twelve zero bytes, and a mask of "0xed,0x01".
5089 *	Note that the pattern matching is done as though frames were not
5090 *	802.11 frames but 802.3 frames, i.e. the frame is fully unpacked
5091 *	first (including SNAP header unpacking) and then matched.
5092 * @NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET: packet offset, pattern is matched after
5093 *	these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5094 * @NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT: number of attributes
5095 * @MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT: max attribute number
5096 */
5097enum nl80211_packet_pattern_attr {
5098	__NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID,
5099	NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK,
5100	NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN,
5101	NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET,
5102
5103	NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT,
5104	MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT = NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT - 1,
5105};
5106
5107/**
5108 * struct nl80211_pattern_support - packet pattern support information
5109 * @max_patterns: maximum number of patterns supported
5110 * @min_pattern_len: minimum length of each pattern
5111 * @max_pattern_len: maximum length of each pattern
5112 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5113 *
5114 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN when
5115 * that is part of %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED or in
5116 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN when that is part of
5117 * %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the capability information given
5118 * by the kernel to userspace.
5119 */
5120struct nl80211_pattern_support {
5121	__u32 max_patterns;
5122	__u32 min_pattern_len;
5123	__u32 max_pattern_len;
5124	__u32 max_pkt_offset;
5125} __attribute__((packed));
5126
5127/* only for backward compatibility */
5128#define __NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_INVALID __NL80211_PKTPAT_INVALID
5129#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_MASK NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5130#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_PATTERN NL80211_PKTPAT_PATTERN
5131#define NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT_OFFSET NL80211_PKTPAT_OFFSET
5132#define NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT NUM_NL80211_PKTPAT
5133#define MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_PKTPAT MAX_NL80211_PKTPAT
5134#define nl80211_wowlan_pattern_support nl80211_pattern_support
5135
5136/**
5137 * enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers - WoWLAN trigger definitions
5138 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5139 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY: wake up on any activity, do not really put
5140 *	the chip into a special state -- works best with chips that have
5141 *	support for low-power operation already (flag)
5142 *	Note that this mode is incompatible with all of the others, if
5143 *	any others are even supported by the device.
5144 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT: wake up on disconnect, the way disconnect
5145 *	is detected is implementation-specific (flag)
5146 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT: wake up on magic packet (6x 0xff, followed
5147 *	by 16 repetitions of MAC addr, anywhere in payload) (flag)
5148 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN: wake up on the specified packet patterns
5149 *	which are passed in an array of nested attributes, each nested attribute
5150 *	defining a with attributes from &struct nl80211_wowlan_trig_pkt_pattern.
5151 *	Each pattern defines a wakeup packet. Packet offset is associated with
5152 *	each pattern which is used while matching the pattern. The matching is
5153 *	done on the MSDU, i.e. as though the packet was an 802.3 packet, so the
5154 *	pattern matching is done after the packet is converted to the MSDU.
5155 *
5156 *	In %NL80211_ATTR_WOWLAN_TRIGGERS_SUPPORTED, it is a binary attribute
5157 *	carrying a &struct nl80211_pattern_support.
5158 *
5159 *	When reporting wakeup. it is a u32 attribute containing the 0-based
5160 *	index of the pattern that caused the wakeup, in the patterns passed
5161 *	to the kernel when configuring.
5162 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED: Not a real trigger, and cannot be
5163 *	used when setting, used only to indicate that GTK rekeying is supported
5164 *	by the device (flag)
5165 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: wake up on GTK rekey failure (if
5166 *	done by the device) (flag)
5167 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST: wake up on EAP Identity Request
5168 *	packet (flag)
5169 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: wake up on 4-way handshake (flag)
5170 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE: wake up when rfkill is released
5171 *	(on devices that have rfkill in the device) (flag)
5172 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211: For wakeup reporting only, contains
5173 *	the 802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a deauth frame. The frame
5174 *	may be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN
5175 *	attribute contains the original length.
5176 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN: Original length of the 802.11
5177 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211
5178 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5179 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023: For wakeup reporting only, contains the
5180 *	802.11 packet that caused the wakeup, e.g. a magic packet. The frame may
5181 *	be truncated, the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN attribute
5182 *	contains the original length.
5183 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN: Original length of the 802.3
5184 *	packet, may be bigger than the @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023
5185 *	attribute if the packet was truncated somewhere.
5186 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION: TCP connection wake, see DOC section
5187 *	"TCP connection wakeup" for more details. This is a nested attribute
5188 *	containing the exact information for establishing and keeping alive
5189 *	the TCP connection.
5190 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_WAKEUP_MATCH: For wakeup reporting only, the
5191 *	wakeup packet was received on the TCP connection
5192 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST: For wakeup reporting only, the
5193 *	TCP connection was lost or failed to be established
5194 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS: For wakeup reporting only,
5195 *	the TCP connection ran out of tokens to use for data to send to the
5196 *	service
5197 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT: wake up when a configured network
5198 *	is detected.  This is a nested attribute that contains the
5199 *	same attributes used with @NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN.  It
5200 *	specifies how the scan is performed (e.g. the interval, the
5201 *	channels to scan and the initial delay) as well as the scan
5202 *	results that will trigger a wake (i.e. the matchsets).  This
5203 *	attribute is also sent in a response to
5204 *	@NL80211_CMD_GET_WIPHY, indicating the number of match sets
5205 *	supported by the driver (u32).
5206 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS: nested attribute
5207 *	containing an array with information about what triggered the
5208 *	wake up.  If no elements are present in the array, it means
5209 *	that the information is not available.  If more than one
5210 *	element is present, it means that more than one match
5211 *	occurred.
5212 *	Each element in the array is a nested attribute that contains
5213 *	one optional %NL80211_ATTR_SSID attribute and one optional
5214 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES attribute.  At least one of
5215 *	these attributes must be present.  If
5216 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES contains more than one
5217 *	frequency, it means that the match occurred in more than one
5218 *	channel.
5219 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: number of wake on wireless triggers
5220 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG: highest wowlan trigger attribute number
5221 *
5222 * These nested attributes are used to configure the wakeup triggers and
5223 * to report the wakeup reason(s).
5224 */
5225enum nl80211_wowlan_triggers {
5226	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_INVALID,
5227	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_ANY,
5228	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_DISCONNECT,
5229	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_MAGIC_PKT,
5230	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_PKT_PATTERN,
5231	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_SUPPORTED,
5232	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE,
5233	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_EAP_IDENT_REQUEST,
5234	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_4WAY_HANDSHAKE,
5235	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_RFKILL_RELEASE,
5236	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211,
5237	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_80211_LEN,
5238	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023,
5239	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_PKT_8023_LEN,
5240	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_TCP_CONNECTION,
5241	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_MATCH,
5242	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_CONNLOST,
5243	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_WAKEUP_TCP_NOMORETOKENS,
5244	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT,
5245	NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG_NET_DETECT_RESULTS,
5246
5247	/* keep last */
5248	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG,
5249	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TRIG - 1
5250};
5251
5252/**
5253 * DOC: TCP connection wakeup
5254 *
5255 * Some devices can establish a TCP connection in order to be woken up by a
5256 * packet coming in from outside their network segment, or behind NAT. If
5257 * configured, the device will establish a TCP connection to the given
5258 * service, and periodically send data to that service. The first data
5259 * packet is usually transmitted after SYN/ACK, also ACKing the SYN/ACK.
5260 * The data packets can optionally include a (little endian) sequence
5261 * number (in the TCP payload!) that is generated by the device, and, also
5262 * optionally, a token from a list of tokens. This serves as a keep-alive
5263 * with the service, and for NATed connections, etc.
5264 *
5265 * During this keep-alive period, the server doesn't send any data to the
5266 * client. When receiving data, it is compared against the wakeup pattern
5267 * (and mask) and if it matches, the host is woken up. Similarly, if the
5268 * connection breaks or cannot be established to start with, the host is
5269 * also woken up.
5270 *
5271 * Developer's note: ARP offload is required for this, otherwise TCP
5272 * response packets might not go through correctly.
5273 */
5274
5275/**
5276 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq - WoWLAN TCP data sequence
5277 * @start: starting value
5278 * @offset: offset of sequence number in packet
5279 * @len: length of the sequence value to write, 1 through 4
5280 *
5281 * Note: don't confuse with the TCP sequence number(s), this is for the
5282 * keepalive packet payload. The actual value is written into the packet
5283 * in little endian.
5284 */
5285struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq {
5286	__u32 start, offset, len;
5287};
5288
5289/**
5290 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token - WoWLAN TCP data token config
5291 * @offset: offset of token in packet
5292 * @len: length of each token
5293 * @token_stream: stream of data to be used for the tokens, the length must
5294 *	be a multiple of @len for this to make sense
5295 */
5296struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token {
5297	__u32 offset, len;
5298	__u8 token_stream[];
5299};
5300
5301/**
5302 * struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature - data token features
5303 * @min_len: minimum token length
5304 * @max_len: maximum token length
5305 * @bufsize: total available token buffer size (max size of @token_stream)
5306 */
5307struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature {
5308	__u32 min_len, max_len, bufsize;
5309};
5310
5311/**
5312 * enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs - WoWLAN TCP connection parameters
5313 * @__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5314 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4: source IPv4 address (in network byte order)
5315 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4: destination IPv4 address
5316 *	(in network byte order)
5317 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC: destination MAC address, this is given because
5318 *	route lookup when configured might be invalid by the time we suspend,
5319 *	and doing a route lookup when suspending is no longer possible as it
5320 *	might require ARP querying.
5321 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT: source port (u16); optional, if not given a
5322 *	socket and port will be allocated
5323 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT: destination port (u16)
5324 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD: data packet payload, at least one byte.
5325 *	For feature advertising, a u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5326 *	of the data payload.
5327 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ: data packet sequence configuration
5328 *	(if desired), a &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq. For feature
5329 *	advertising it is just a flag
5330 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN: data packet token configuration,
5331 *	see &struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token and for advertising see
5332 *	&struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature.
5333 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL: data interval in seconds, maximum
5334 *	interval in feature advertising (u32)
5335 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD: wake packet payload, for advertising a
5336 *	u32 attribute holding the maximum length
5337 * @NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK: Wake packet payload mask, not used for
5338 *	feature advertising. The mask works like @NL80211_PKTPAT_MASK
5339 *	but on the TCP payload only.
5340 * @NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: number of TCP attributes
5341 * @MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP: highest attribute number
5342 */
5343enum nl80211_wowlan_tcp_attrs {
5344	__NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_INVALID,
5345	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_IPV4,
5346	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_IPV4,
5347	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_MAC,
5348	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_SRC_PORT,
5349	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DST_PORT,
5350	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD,
5351	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_SEQ,
5352	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_PAYLOAD_TOKEN,
5353	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_DATA_INTERVAL,
5354	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_PAYLOAD,
5355	NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP_WAKE_MASK,
5356
5357	/* keep last */
5358	NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP,
5359	MAX_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP = NUM_NL80211_WOWLAN_TCP - 1
5360};
5361
5362/**
5363 * struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support - coalesce rule support information
5364 * @max_rules: maximum number of rules supported
5365 * @pat: packet pattern support information
5366 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5367 *
5368 * This struct is carried in %NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE in the
5369 * capability information given by the kernel to userspace.
5370 */
5371struct nl80211_coalesce_rule_support {
5372	__u32 max_rules;
5373	struct nl80211_pattern_support pat;
5374	__u32 max_delay;
5375} __attribute__((packed));
5376
5377/**
5378 * enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule - coalesce rule attribute
5379 * @__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5380 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY: delay in msecs used for packet coalescing
5381 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION: condition for packet coalescence,
5382 *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
5383 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN: packet offset, pattern is matched
5384 *	after these fixed number of bytes of received packet
5385 * @NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE: number of attributes
5386 * @NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX: max attribute number
5387 */
5388enum nl80211_attr_coalesce_rule {
5389	__NL80211_COALESCE_RULE_INVALID,
5390	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_DELAY,
5391	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_CONDITION,
5392	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_PKT_PATTERN,
5393
5394	/* keep last */
5395	NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE,
5396	NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_ATTR_COALESCE_RULE - 1
5397};
5398
5399/**
5400 * enum nl80211_coalesce_condition - coalesce rule conditions
5401 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH: coalaesce Rx packets when patterns
5402 *	in a rule are matched.
5403 * @NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH: coalesce Rx packets when patterns
5404 *	in a rule are not matched.
5405 */
5406enum nl80211_coalesce_condition {
5407	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_MATCH,
5408	NL80211_COALESCE_CONDITION_NO_MATCH
5409};
5410
5411/**
5412 * enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs - limit attributes
5413 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5414 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX: maximum number of interfaces that
5415 *	can be chosen from this set of interface types (u32)
5416 * @NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES: nested attribute containing a
5417 *	flag attribute for each interface type in this set
5418 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: number of attributes
5419 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT: highest attribute number
5420 */
5421enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs {
5422	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_UNSPEC,
5423	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_MAX,
5424	NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT_TYPES,
5425
5426	/* keep last */
5427	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT,
5428	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_LIMIT - 1
5429};
5430
5431/**
5432 * enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs -- interface combination attributes
5433 *
5434 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC: (reserved)
5435 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS: Nested attributes containing the limits
5436 *	for given interface types, see &enum nl80211_iface_limit_attrs.
5437 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM: u32 attribute giving the total number of
5438 *	interfaces that can be created in this group. This number doesn't
5439 *	apply to interfaces purely managed in software, which are listed
5440 *	in a separate attribute %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACES_SOFTWARE.
5441 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH: flag attribute specifying that
5442 *	beacon intervals within this group must be all the same even for
5443 *	infrastructure and AP/GO combinations, i.e. the GO(s) must adopt
5444 *	the infrastructure network's beacon interval.
5445 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS: u32 attribute specifying how many
5446 *	different channels may be used within this group.
5447 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5448 *	of supported channel widths for radar detection.
5449 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS: u32 attribute containing the bitmap
5450 *	of supported regulatory regions for radar detection.
5451 * @NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD: u32 attribute specifying the minimum GCD of
5452 *	different beacon intervals supported by all the interface combinations
5453 *	in this group (if not present, all beacon intervals be identical).
5454 * @NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: number of attributes
5455 * @MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB: highest attribute number
5456 *
5457 * Examples:
5458 *	limits = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{AP} <= 1 ], matching BI, channels = 1, max = 2
5459 *	=> allows an AP and a STA that must match BIs
5460 *
5461 *	numbers = [ #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8 ], BI min gcd, channels = 1, max = 8,
5462 *	=> allows 8 of AP/GO that can have BI gcd >= min gcd
5463 *
5464 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 2 ], channels = 2, max = 2
5465 *	=> allows two STAs on different channels
5466 *
5467 *	numbers = [ #{STA} <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 ], max = 4
5468 *	=> allows a STA plus three P2P interfaces
5469 *
5470 * The list of these four possibilities could completely be contained
5471 * within the %NL80211_ATTR_INTERFACE_COMBINATIONS attribute to indicate
5472 * that any of these groups must match.
5473 *
5474 * "Combinations" of just a single interface will not be listed here,
5475 * a single interface of any valid interface type is assumed to always
5476 * be possible by itself. This means that implicitly, for each valid
5477 * interface type, the following group always exists:
5478 *	numbers = [ #{<type>} <= 1 ], channels = 1, max = 1
5479 */
5480enum nl80211_if_combination_attrs {
5481	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_UNSPEC,
5482	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_LIMITS,
5483	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_MAXNUM,
5484	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_STA_AP_BI_MATCH,
5485	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_NUM_CHANNELS,
5486	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_WIDTHS,
5487	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_RADAR_DETECT_REGIONS,
5488	NL80211_IFACE_COMB_BI_MIN_GCD,
5489
5490	/* keep last */
5491	NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB,
5492	MAX_NL80211_IFACE_COMB = NUM_NL80211_IFACE_COMB - 1
5493};
5494
5495
5496/**
5497 * enum nl80211_plink_state - state of a mesh peer link finite state machine
5498 *
5499 * @NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN: initial state, considered the implicit
5500 *	state of non existent mesh peer links
5501 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT: mesh plink open frame has been sent to
5502 *	this mesh peer
5503 * @NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD: mesh plink open frame has been received
5504 *	from this mesh peer
5505 * @NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD: mesh plink confirm frame has been
5506 *	received from this mesh peer
5507 * @NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB: mesh peer link is established
5508 * @NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING: mesh peer link is being closed or cancelled
5509 * @NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED: all frames transmitted from this mesh
5510 *	plink are discarded
5511 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: number of peer link states
5512 * @MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES: highest numerical value of plink states
5513 */
5514enum nl80211_plink_state {
5515	NL80211_PLINK_LISTEN,
5516	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_SNT,
5517	NL80211_PLINK_OPN_RCVD,
5518	NL80211_PLINK_CNF_RCVD,
5519	NL80211_PLINK_ESTAB,
5520	NL80211_PLINK_HOLDING,
5521	NL80211_PLINK_BLOCKED,
5522
5523	/* keep last */
5524	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES,
5525	MAX_NL80211_PLINK_STATES = NUM_NL80211_PLINK_STATES - 1
5526};
5527
5528/**
5529 * enum nl80211_plink_action - actions to perform in mesh peers
5530 *
5531 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION: perform no action
5532 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN: start mesh peer link establishment
5533 * @NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK: block traffic from this mesh peer
5534 * @NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS: number of possible actions
5535 */
5536enum plink_actions {
5537	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_NO_ACTION,
5538	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_OPEN,
5539	NL80211_PLINK_ACTION_BLOCK,
5540
5541	NUM_NL80211_PLINK_ACTIONS,
5542};
5543
5544
5545#define NL80211_KCK_LEN			16
5546#define NL80211_KEK_LEN			16
5547#define NL80211_KCK_EXT_LEN		24
5548#define NL80211_KEK_EXT_LEN		32
5549#define NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN		8
5550
5551/**
5552 * enum nl80211_rekey_data - attributes for GTK rekey offload
5553 * @__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5554 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK: key encryption key (binary)
5555 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK: key confirmation key (binary)
5556 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR: replay counter (binary)
5557 * @NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM: AKM data (OUI, suite type)
5558 * @NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: number of rekey attributes (internal)
5559 * @MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA: highest rekey attribute (internal)
5560 */
5561enum nl80211_rekey_data {
5562	__NL80211_REKEY_DATA_INVALID,
5563	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KEK,
5564	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_KCK,
5565	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_REPLAY_CTR,
5566	NL80211_REKEY_DATA_AKM,
5567
5568	/* keep last */
5569	NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA,
5570	MAX_NL80211_REKEY_DATA = NUM_NL80211_REKEY_DATA - 1
5571};
5572
5573/**
5574 * enum nl80211_hidden_ssid - values for %NL80211_ATTR_HIDDEN_SSID
5575 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE: do not hide SSID (i.e., broadcast it in
5576 *	Beacon frames)
5577 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN: hide SSID by using zero-length SSID element
5578 *	in Beacon frames
5579 * @NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS: hide SSID by using correct length of SSID
5580 *	element in Beacon frames but zero out each byte in the SSID
5581 */
5582enum nl80211_hidden_ssid {
5583	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_NOT_IN_USE,
5584	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_LEN,
5585	NL80211_HIDDEN_SSID_ZERO_CONTENTS
5586};
5587
5588/**
5589 * enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr - station WME attributes
5590 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID: invalid number for nested attribute
5591 * @NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES: bitmap of uapsd queues. the format
5592 *	is the same as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field.
5593 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP: max service period. the format is the same
5594 *	as the MAX_SP field in the QoS info field (but already shifted down).
5595 * @__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST: internal
5596 * @NL80211_STA_WME_MAX: highest station WME attribute
5597 */
5598enum nl80211_sta_wme_attr {
5599	__NL80211_STA_WME_INVALID,
5600	NL80211_STA_WME_UAPSD_QUEUES,
5601	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX_SP,
5602
5603	/* keep last */
5604	__NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST,
5605	NL80211_STA_WME_MAX = __NL80211_STA_WME_AFTER_LAST - 1
5606};
5607
5608/**
5609 * enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr - attributes for PMKSA caching candidates
5610 * @__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID: invalid number for nested attributes
5611 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX: candidate index (u32; the smaller, the higher
5612 *	priority)
5613 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID: candidate BSSID (6 octets)
5614 * @NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH: RSN pre-authentication supported (flag)
5615 * @NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: number of PMKSA caching candidate attributes
5616 *	(internal)
5617 * @MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE: highest PMKSA caching candidate attribute
5618 *	(internal)
5619 */
5620enum nl80211_pmksa_candidate_attr {
5621	__NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INVALID,
5622	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_INDEX,
5623	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_BSSID,
5624	NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE_PREAUTH,
5625
5626	/* keep last */
5627	NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE,
5628	MAX_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE = NUM_NL80211_PMKSA_CANDIDATE - 1
5629};
5630
5631/**
5632 * enum nl80211_tdls_operation - values for %NL80211_ATTR_TDLS_OPERATION
5633 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ: Send a TDLS discovery request
5634 * @NL80211_TDLS_SETUP: Setup TDLS link
5635 * @NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN: Teardown a TDLS link which is already established
5636 * @NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK: Enable TDLS link
5637 * @NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK: Disable TDLS link
5638 */
5639enum nl80211_tdls_operation {
5640	NL80211_TDLS_DISCOVERY_REQ,
5641	NL80211_TDLS_SETUP,
5642	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN,
5643	NL80211_TDLS_ENABLE_LINK,
5644	NL80211_TDLS_DISABLE_LINK,
5645};
5646
5647/*
5648 * enum nl80211_ap_sme_features - device-integrated AP features
5649 * Reserved for future use, no bits are defined in
5650 * NL80211_ATTR_DEVICE_AP_SME yet.
5651enum nl80211_ap_sme_features {
5652};
5653 */
5654
5655/**
5656 * enum nl80211_feature_flags - device/driver features
5657 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS: This driver supports reflecting back
5658 *	TX status to the socket error queue when requested with the
5659 *	socket option.
5660 * @NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with HT datarates.
5661 * @NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER: This driver takes care of freeing up
5662 *	the connected inactive stations in AP mode.
5663 * @NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS: This driver has been tested
5664 *	to work properly to suppport receiving regulatory hints from
5665 *	cellular base stations.
5666 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL: (no longer available, only
5667 *	here to reserve the value for API/ABI compatibility)
5668 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SAE: This driver supports simultaneous authentication of
5669 *	equals (SAE) with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station
5670 *	mode
5671 * @NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN: This driver supports low priority scan
5672 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH: Scan flush is supported
5673 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN: Support scanning using an AP vif
5674 * @NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER: The driver supports per-vif TX power setting
5675 * @NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN: The driver expects userspace to perform
5676 *	OBSS scans and generate 20/40 BSS coex reports. This flag is used only
5677 *	for drivers implementing the CONNECT API, for AUTH/ASSOC it is implied.
5678 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN: P2P GO implementation supports CT Window
5679 *	setting
5680 * @NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS: P2P GO implementation supports opportunistic
5681 *	powersave
5682 * @NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE: The driver supports full state
5683 *	transitions for AP clients. Without this flag (and if the driver
5684 *	doesn't have the AP SME in the device) the driver supports adding
5685 *	stations only when they're associated and adds them in associated
5686 *	state (to later be transitioned into authorized), with this flag
5687 *	they should be added before even sending the authentication reply
5688 *	and then transitioned into authenticated, associated and authorized
5689 *	states using station flags.
5690 *	Note that even for drivers that support this, the default is to add
5691 *	stations in authenticated/associated state, so to add unauthenticated
5692 *	stations the authenticated/associated bits have to be set in the mask.
5693 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS: cfg80211 advertises channel limits
5694 *	(HT40, VHT 80/160 MHz) if this flag is set
5695 * @NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM: This driver supports a userspace Mesh
5696 *	Peering Management entity which may be implemented by registering for
5697 *	beacons or NL80211_CMD_NEW_PEER_CANDIDATE events. The mesh beacon is
5698 *	still generated by the driver.
5699 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR: This driver supports an active monitor
5700 *	interface. An active monitor interface behaves like a normal monitor
5701 *	interface, but gets added to the driver. It ensures that incoming
5702 *	unicast packets directed at the configured interface address get ACKed.
5703 * @NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE: This driver supports dynamic
5704 *	channel bandwidth change (e.g., HT 20 <-> 40 MHz channel) during the
5705 *	lifetime of a BSS.
5706 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a DS Parameter
5707 *	Set IE to probe requests.
5708 * @NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES: This device adds a WFA TPC Report IE
5709 *	to probe requests.
5710 * @NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET: This device, in client mode, supports Quiet Period
5711 *	requests sent to it by an AP.
5712 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION: This device is capable of inserting the
5713 *	current tx power value into the TPC Report IE in the spectrum
5714 *	management TPC Report action frame, and in the Radio Measurement Link
5715 *	Measurement Report action frame.
5716 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION: This driver supports dynamic ACK timeout
5717 *	estimation (dynack). %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_DYN_ACK flag attribute is used
5718 *	to enable dynack.
5719 * @NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS: Device supports static spatial
5720 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5721 *	even on HT connections that should be using more chains.
5722 * @NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS: Device supports dynamic spatial
5723 *	multiplexing powersave, ie. can turn off all but one chain
5724 *	and then wake the rest up as required after, for example,
5725 *	rts/cts handshake.
5726 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION: the device supports setting up WMM
5727 *	TSPEC sessions (TID aka TSID 0-7) with the %NL80211_CMD_ADD_TX_TS
5728 *	command. Standard IEEE 802.11 TSPEC setup is not yet supported, it
5729 *	needs to be able to handle Block-Ack agreements and other things.
5730 * @NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE: Device supports configuring
5731 *	the vif's MAC address upon creation.
5732 *	See 'macaddr' field in the vif_params (cfg80211.h).
5733 * @NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Driver supports channel switching when
5734 *	operating as a TDLS peer.
5735 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5736 *	random MAC address during scan (if the device is unassociated); the
5737 *	%NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR flag may be set for scans and the MAC
5738 *	address mask/value will be used.
5739 * @NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports
5740 *	using a random MAC address for every scan iteration during scheduled
5741 *	scan (while not associated), the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5742 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5743 * @NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR: This device/driver supports using a
5744 *	random MAC address for every scan iteration during "net detect", i.e.
5745 *	scan in unassociated WoWLAN, the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR may
5746 *	be set for scheduled scan and the MAC address mask/value will be used.
5747 */
5748enum nl80211_feature_flags {
5749	NL80211_FEATURE_SK_TX_STATUS			= 1 << 0,
5750	NL80211_FEATURE_HT_IBSS				= 1 << 1,
5751	NL80211_FEATURE_INACTIVITY_TIMER		= 1 << 2,
5752	NL80211_FEATURE_CELL_BASE_REG_HINTS		= 1 << 3,
5753	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_DEVICE_NEEDS_CHANNEL	= 1 << 4,
5754	NL80211_FEATURE_SAE				= 1 << 5,
5755	NL80211_FEATURE_LOW_PRIORITY_SCAN		= 1 << 6,
5756	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_FLUSH			= 1 << 7,
5757	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_SCAN				= 1 << 8,
5758	NL80211_FEATURE_VIF_TXPOWER			= 1 << 9,
5759	NL80211_FEATURE_NEED_OBSS_SCAN			= 1 << 10,
5760	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_CTWIN			= 1 << 11,
5761	NL80211_FEATURE_P2P_GO_OPPPS			= 1 << 12,
5762	/* bit 13 is reserved */
5763	NL80211_FEATURE_ADVERTISE_CHAN_LIMITS		= 1 << 14,
5764	NL80211_FEATURE_FULL_AP_CLIENT_STATE		= 1 << 15,
5765	NL80211_FEATURE_USERSPACE_MPM			= 1 << 16,
5766	NL80211_FEATURE_ACTIVE_MONITOR			= 1 << 17,
5767	NL80211_FEATURE_AP_MODE_CHAN_WIDTH_CHANGE	= 1 << 18,
5768	NL80211_FEATURE_DS_PARAM_SET_IE_IN_PROBES	= 1 << 19,
5769	NL80211_FEATURE_WFA_TPC_IE_IN_PROBES		= 1 << 20,
5770	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET				= 1 << 21,
5771	NL80211_FEATURE_TX_POWER_INSERTION		= 1 << 22,
5772	NL80211_FEATURE_ACKTO_ESTIMATION		= 1 << 23,
5773	NL80211_FEATURE_STATIC_SMPS			= 1 << 24,
5774	NL80211_FEATURE_DYNAMIC_SMPS			= 1 << 25,
5775	NL80211_FEATURE_SUPPORTS_WMM_ADMISSION		= 1 << 26,
5776	NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE			= 1 << 27,
5777	NL80211_FEATURE_TDLS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= 1 << 28,
5778	NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1 << 29,
5779	NL80211_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR	= 1 << 30,
5780	NL80211_FEATURE_ND_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR		= 1U << 31,
5781};
5782
5783/**
5784 * enum nl80211_ext_feature_index - bit index of extended features.
5785 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS: This driver supports IBSS with VHT datarates.
5786 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM: This driver supports RRM. When featured, user can
5787 *	request to use RRM (see %NL80211_ATTR_USE_RRM) with
5788 *	%NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT requests, which will set
5789 *	the ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM flag in the association request even if
5790 *	NL80211_FEATURE_QUIET is not advertized.
5791 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER: This device supports MU-MIMO air
5792 *	sniffer which means that it can be configured to hear packets from
5793 *	certain groups which can be configured by the
5794 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_GROUP_DATA attribute,
5795 *	or can be configured to follow a station by configuring the
5796 *	%NL80211_ATTR_MU_MIMO_FOLLOW_MAC_ADDR attribute.
5797 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME: This driver includes the actual
5798 *	time the scan started in scan results event. The time is the TSF of
5799 *	the BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5800 *	(if available).
5801 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF: Per BSS, this driver reports the
5802 *	time the last beacon/probe was received. The time is the TSF of the
5803 *	BSS that the interface that requested the scan is connected to
5804 *	(if available).
5805 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL: This driver supports configuration of
5806 *	channel dwell time.
5807 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY: Driver supports beacon rate
5808 *	configuration (AP/mesh), supporting a legacy (non HT/VHT) rate.
5809 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT: Driver supports beacon rate
5810 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HT rates.
5811 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT: Driver supports beacon rate
5812 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with VHT rates.
5813 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA: This driver supports Fast Initial Link Setup
5814 *	with user space SME (NL80211_CMD_AUTHENTICATE) in station mode.
5815 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA: This driver supports randomized TA
5816 *	in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while not associated.
5817 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED: This driver supports
5818 *	randomized TA in @NL80211_CMD_FRAME while associated.
5819 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI: The driver supports sched_scan
5820 *	for reporting BSSs with better RSSI than the current connected BSS
5821 *	(%NL80211_ATTR_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI).
5822 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST: With this driver the
5823 *	%NL80211_ATTR_CQM_RSSI_THOLD attribute accepts a list of zero or more
5824 *	RSSI threshold values to monitor rather than exactly one threshold.
5825 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD: Driver SME supports FILS shared key
5826 *	authentication with %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT.
5827 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5828 *	handshake with PSK in station mode (PSK is passed as part of the connect
5829 *	and associate commands), doing it in the host might not be supported.
5830 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X: Device wants to do doing 4-way
5831 *	handshake with 802.1X in station mode (will pass EAP frames to the host
5832 *	and accept the set_pmk/del_pmk commands), doing it in the host might not
5833 *	be supported.
5834 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: Driver is capable of overriding
5835 *	the max channel attribute in the FILS request params IE with the
5836 *	actual dwell time.
5837 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver accepts broadcast probe
5838 *	response
5839 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: Driver supports sending
5840 *	the first probe request in each channel at rate of at least 5.5Mbps.
5841 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: Driver supports
5842 *	probe request tx deferral and suppression
5843 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL: Driver supports the %NL80211_MFP_OPTIONAL
5844 *	value in %NL80211_ATTR_USE_MFP.
5845 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN: Driver supports low span scan.
5846 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN: Driver supports low power scan.
5847 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN: Driver supports high accuracy scan.
5848 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD: HW/driver will offload DFS actions.
5849 *	Device or driver will do all DFS-related actions by itself,
5850 *	informing user-space about CAC progress, radar detection event,
5851 *	channel change triggered by radar detection event.
5852 *	No need to start CAC from user-space, no need to react to
5853 *	"radar detected" event.
5854 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211: Driver supports sending and
5855 *	receiving control port frames over nl80211 instead of the netdevice.
5856 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT: This driver/device supports
5857 *	(average) ACK signal strength reporting.
5858 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS: Driver supports FQ-CoDel-enabled intermediate
5859 *      TXQs.
5860 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN: Driver/device supports randomizing the
5861 *	SN in probe request frames if requested by %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN.
5862 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: Driver/device can omit all data
5863 *	except for supported rates from the probe request content if requested
5864 *	by the %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT flag.
5865 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER: Driver supports enabling fine
5866 *	timing measurement responder role.
5867 *
5868 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0: Driver/device confirm that they are
5869 *      able to rekey an in-use key correctly. Userspace must not rekey PTK keys
5870 *      if this flag is not set. Ignoring this can leak clear text packets and/or
5871 *      freeze the connection.
5872 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID: Driver supports "Extended Key ID for
5873 *      Individually Addressed Frames" from IEEE802.11-2016.
5874 *
5875 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS: Driver supports getting airtime
5876 *	fairness for transmitted packets and has enabled airtime fairness
5877 *	scheduling.
5878 *
5879 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING: Driver/device supports PMKSA caching
5880 *	(set/del PMKSA operations) in AP mode.
5881 *
5882 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD: Driver supports
5883 *	filtering of sched scan results using band specific RSSI thresholds.
5884 *
5885 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR: This driver supports controlling tx power
5886 *	to a station.
5887 *
5888 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD: Device wants to do SAE authentication in
5889 *	station mode (SAE password is passed as part of the connect command).
5890 *
5891 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD: The driver supports a single netdev
5892 *	with VLAN tagged frames and separate VLAN-specific netdevs added using
5893 *	vconfig similarly to the Ethernet case.
5894 *
5895 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL: The driver supports the Airtime Queue Limit (AQL)
5896 *	feature, which prevents bufferbloat by using the expected transmission
5897 *	time to limit the amount of data buffered in the hardware.
5898 *
5899 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION: The driver supports Beacon protection
5900 *	and can receive key configuration for BIGTK using key indexes 6 and 7.
5901 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT: The driver supports Beacon
5902 *	protection as a client only and cannot transmit protected beacons.
5903 *
5904 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH: The driver can disable the
5905 *	forwarding of preauth frames over the control port. They are then
5906 *	handled as ordinary data frames.
5907 *
5908 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT: Driver supports protected TWT frames
5909 *
5910 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA: The driver supports removing stations
5911 *      in IBSS mode, essentially by dropping their state.
5912 *
5913 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS: management frame registrations
5914 *	are possible for multicast frames and those will be reported properly.
5915 *
5916 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ: This driver supports receiving and
5917 *	reporting scan request with %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. In order to
5918 *	report %NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ, %NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ must be
5919 *	included in the scan request.
5920 *
5921 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS: The driver
5922 *	can report tx status for control port over nl80211 tx operations.
5923 *
5924 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION: Driver supports Operating
5925 *	Channel Validation (OCV) when using driver's SME for RSNA handshakes.
5926 *
5927 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK: Device wants to do 4-way
5928 *	handshake with PSK in AP mode (PSK is passed as part of the start AP
5929 *	command).
5930 *
5931 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP: Device wants to do SAE authentication
5932 *	in AP mode (SAE password is passed as part of the start AP command).
5933 *
5934 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY: Driver/device supports FILS discovery
5935 *	frames transmission
5936 *
5937 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Driver/device supports
5938 *	unsolicited broadcast probe response transmission
5939 *
5940 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE: Driver supports beacon rate
5941 *	configuration (AP/mesh) with HE rates.
5942 *
5943 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF: Device supports secure LTF measurement
5944 *      exchange protocol.
5945 *
5946 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT: Device supports secure RTT measurement
5947 *      exchange protocol.
5948 *
5949 * @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE: Device supports management
5950 *      frame protection for all management frames exchanged during the
5951 *      negotiation and range measurement procedure.
5952 *
5953 * @NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: number of extended features.
5954 * @MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES: highest extended feature index.
5955 */
5956enum nl80211_ext_feature_index {
5957	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VHT_IBSS,
5958	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_RRM,
5959	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MU_MIMO_AIR_SNIFFER,
5960	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_START_TIME,
5961	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BSS_PARENT_TSF,
5962	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SET_SCAN_DWELL,
5963	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_LEGACY,
5964	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HT,
5965	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_VHT,
5966	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_STA,
5967	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA,
5968	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MGMT_TX_RANDOM_TA_CONNECTED,
5969	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_RELATIVE_RSSI,
5970	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST,
5971	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_SK_OFFLOAD,
5972	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_PSK,
5973	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_STA_1X,
5974	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME,
5975	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
5976	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE,
5977	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION,
5978	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MFP_OPTIONAL,
5979	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_SPAN_SCAN,
5980	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_LOW_POWER_SCAN,
5981	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_HIGH_ACCURACY_SCAN,
5982	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD,
5983	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211,
5984	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5985	/* we renamed this - stay compatible */
5986	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DATA_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT = NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ACK_SIGNAL_SUPPORT,
5987	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_TXQS,
5988	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_SN,
5989	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT,
5990	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0,
5991	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_ENABLE_FTM_RESPONDER,
5992	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AIRTIME_FAIRNESS,
5993	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AP_PMKSA_CACHING,
5994	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD,
5995	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_EXT_KEY_ID,
5996	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_STA_TX_PWR,
5997	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD,
5998	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_VLAN_OFFLOAD,
5999	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_AQL,
6000	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION,
6001	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_NO_PREAUTH,
6002	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROTECTED_TWT,
6003	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DEL_IBSS_STA,
6004	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_MULTICAST_REGISTRATIONS,
6005	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_PROTECTION_CLIENT,
6006	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ,
6007	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CONTROL_PORT_OVER_NL80211_TX_STATUS,
6008	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_OPERATING_CHANNEL_VALIDATION,
6009	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_4WAY_HANDSHAKE_AP_PSK,
6010	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SAE_OFFLOAD_AP,
6011	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_FILS_DISCOVERY,
6012	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP,
6013	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_BEACON_RATE_HE,
6014	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_LTF,
6015	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SECURE_RTT,
6016	NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_PROT_RANGE_NEGO_AND_MEASURE,
6017
6018	/* add new features before the definition below */
6019	NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES,
6020	MAX_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES = NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES - 1
6021};
6022
6023/**
6024 * enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr - optional supported
6025 *	protocols for probe-response offloading by the driver/FW.
6026 *	To be used with the %NL80211_ATTR_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD attribute.
6027 *	Each enum value represents a bit in the bitmap of supported
6028 *	protocols. Typically a subset of probe-requests belonging to a
6029 *	supported protocol will be excluded from offload and uploaded
6030 *	to the host.
6031 *
6032 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS: Support for WPS ver. 1
6033 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2: Support for WPS ver. 2
6034 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P: Support for P2P
6035 * @NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U: Support for 802.11u
6036 */
6037enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr {
6038	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS =	1<<0,
6039	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_WPS2 =	1<<1,
6040	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_P2P =	1<<2,
6041	NL80211_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD_SUPPORT_80211U =	1<<3,
6042};
6043
6044/**
6045 * enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason - connection request failed reasons
6046 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS: Maximum number of clients that can be
6047 *	handled by the AP is reached.
6048 * @NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT: Connection request is rejected due to ACL.
6049 */
6050enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason {
6051	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_MAX_CLIENTS,
6052	NL80211_CONN_FAIL_BLOCKED_CLIENT,
6053};
6054
6055/**
6056 * enum nl80211_timeout_reason - timeout reasons
6057 *
6058 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED: Timeout reason unspecified.
6059 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN: Scan (AP discovery) timed out.
6060 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH: Authentication timed out.
6061 * @NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC: Association timed out.
6062 */
6063enum nl80211_timeout_reason {
6064	NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED,
6065	NL80211_TIMEOUT_SCAN,
6066	NL80211_TIMEOUT_AUTH,
6067	NL80211_TIMEOUT_ASSOC,
6068};
6069
6070/**
6071 * enum nl80211_scan_flags -  scan request control flags
6072 *
6073 * Scan request control flags are used to control the handling
6074 * of NL80211_CMD_TRIGGER_SCAN and NL80211_CMD_START_SCHED_SCAN
6075 * requests.
6076 *
6077 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN, NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER, and
6078 * NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY flags are exclusive of each other, i.e., only
6079 * one of them can be used in the request.
6080 *
6081 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY: scan request has low priority
6082 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH: flush cache before scanning
6083 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP: force a scan even if the interface is configured
6084 *	as AP and the beaconing has already been configured. This attribute is
6085 *	dangerous because will destroy stations performance as a lot of frames
6086 *	will be lost while scanning off-channel, therefore it must be used only
6087 *	when really needed
6088 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR: use a random MAC address for this scan (or
6089 *	for scheduled scan: a different one for every scan iteration). When the
6090 *	flag is set, depending on device capabilities the @NL80211_ATTR_MAC and
6091 *	@NL80211_ATTR_MAC_MASK attributes may also be given in which case only
6092 *	the masked bits will be preserved from the MAC address and the remainder
6093 *	randomised. If the attributes are not given full randomisation (46 bits,
6094 *	locally administered 1, multicast 0) is assumed.
6095 *	This flag must not be requested when the feature isn't supported, check
6096 *	the nl80211 feature flags for the device.
6097 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME: fill the dwell time in the FILS
6098 *	request parameters IE in the probe request
6099 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: accept broadcast probe responses
6100 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE: send probe request frames at
6101 *	rate of at least 5.5M. In case non OCE AP is discovered in the channel,
6102 *	only the first probe req in the channel will be sent in high rate.
6103 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION: allow probe request
6104 *	tx deferral (dot11FILSProbeDelay shall be set to 15ms)
6105 *	and suppression (if it has received a broadcast Probe Response frame,
6106 *	Beacon frame or FILS Discovery frame from an AP that the STA considers
6107 *	a suitable candidate for (re-)association - suitable in terms of
6108 *	SSID and/or RSSI.
6109 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN: Span corresponds to the total time taken to
6110 *	accomplish the scan. Thus, this flag intends the driver to perform the
6111 *	scan request with lesser span/duration. It is specific to the driver
6112 *	implementations on how this is accomplished. Scan accuracy may get
6113 *	impacted with this flag.
6114 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER: This flag intends the scan attempts to consume
6115 *	optimal possible power. Drivers can resort to their specific means to
6116 *	optimize the power. Scan accuracy may get impacted with this flag.
6117 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY: Accuracy here intends to the extent of scan
6118 *	results obtained. Thus HIGH_ACCURACY scan flag aims to get maximum
6119 *	possible scan results. This flag hints the driver to use the best
6120 *	possible scan configuration to improve the accuracy in scanning.
6121 *	Latency and power use may get impacted with this flag.
6122 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN: randomize the sequence number in probe
6123 *	request frames from this scan to avoid correlation/tracking being
6124 *	possible.
6125 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT: minimize probe request content to
6126 *	only have supported rates and no additional capabilities (unless
6127 *	added by userspace explicitly.)
6128 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ: report scan results with
6129 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQ_KHZ. This also means
6130 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SCAN_FREQUENCIES will not be included.
6131 * @NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ: scan for colocated APs reported by
6132 *	2.4/5 GHz APs
6133 */
6134enum nl80211_scan_flags {
6135	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_PRIORITY				= 1<<0,
6136	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FLUSH					= 1<<1,
6137	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_AP					= 1<<2,
6138	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR				= 1<<3,
6139	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FILS_MAX_CHANNEL_TIME			= 1<<4,
6140	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_ACCEPT_BCAST_PROBE_RESP		= 1<<5,
6141	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_HIGH_TX_RATE		= 1<<6,
6142	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_OCE_PROBE_REQ_DEFERRAL_SUPPRESSION	= 1<<7,
6143	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_SPAN				= 1<<8,
6144	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_LOW_POWER				= 1<<9,
6145	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_HIGH_ACCURACY				= 1<<10,
6146	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_SN				= 1<<11,
6147	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_MIN_PREQ_CONTENT			= 1<<12,
6148	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_FREQ_KHZ				= 1<<13,
6149	NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_COLOCATED_6GHZ			= 1<<14,
6150};
6151
6152/**
6153 * enum nl80211_acl_policy - access control policy
6154 *
6155 * Access control policy is applied on a MAC list set by
6156 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP and %NL80211_CMD_SET_MAC_ACL, to
6157 * be used with %NL80211_ATTR_ACL_POLICY.
6158 *
6159 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED: Deny stations which are
6160 *	listed in ACL, i.e. allow all the stations which are not listed
6161 *	in ACL to authenticate.
6162 * @NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED: Allow the stations which are listed
6163 *	in ACL, i.e. deny all the stations which are not listed in ACL.
6164 */
6165enum nl80211_acl_policy {
6166	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_ACCEPT_UNLESS_LISTED,
6167	NL80211_ACL_POLICY_DENY_UNLESS_LISTED,
6168};
6169
6170/**
6171 * enum nl80211_smps_mode - SMPS mode
6172 *
6173 * Requested SMPS mode (for AP mode)
6174 *
6175 * @NL80211_SMPS_OFF: SMPS off (use all antennas).
6176 * @NL80211_SMPS_STATIC: static SMPS (use a single antenna)
6177 * @NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic smps (start with a single antenna and
6178 *	turn on other antennas after CTS/RTS).
6179 */
6180enum nl80211_smps_mode {
6181	NL80211_SMPS_OFF,
6182	NL80211_SMPS_STATIC,
6183	NL80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
6184
6185	__NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST,
6186	NL80211_SMPS_MAX = __NL80211_SMPS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6187};
6188
6189/**
6190 * enum nl80211_radar_event - type of radar event for DFS operation
6191 *
6192 * Type of event to be used with NL80211_ATTR_RADAR_EVENT to inform userspace
6193 * about detected radars or success of the channel available check (CAC)
6194 *
6195 * @NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED: A radar pattern has been detected. The channel is
6196 *	now unusable.
6197 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED: Channel Availability Check has been finished,
6198 *	the channel is now available.
6199 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED: Channel Availability Check has been aborted, no
6200 *	change to the channel status.
6201 * @NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED: The Non-Occupancy Period for this channel is
6202 *	over, channel becomes usable.
6203 * @NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED: Channel Availability Check done on this
6204 *	non-operating channel is expired and no longer valid. New CAC must
6205 *	be done on this channel before starting the operation. This is not
6206 *	applicable for ETSI dfs domain where pre-CAC is valid for ever.
6207 * @NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED: Channel Availability Check has been started,
6208 *	should be generated by HW if NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_DFS_OFFLOAD is enabled.
6209 */
6210enum nl80211_radar_event {
6211	NL80211_RADAR_DETECTED,
6212	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_FINISHED,
6213	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_ABORTED,
6214	NL80211_RADAR_NOP_FINISHED,
6215	NL80211_RADAR_PRE_CAC_EXPIRED,
6216	NL80211_RADAR_CAC_STARTED,
6217};
6218
6219/**
6220 * enum nl80211_dfs_state - DFS states for channels
6221 *
6222 * Channel states used by the DFS code.
6223 *
6224 * @NL80211_DFS_USABLE: The channel can be used, but channel availability
6225 *	check (CAC) must be performed before using it for AP or IBSS.
6226 * @NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE: A radar has been detected on this channel, it
6227 *	is therefore marked as not available.
6228 * @NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE: The channel has been CAC checked and is available.
6229 */
6230enum nl80211_dfs_state {
6231	NL80211_DFS_USABLE,
6232	NL80211_DFS_UNAVAILABLE,
6233	NL80211_DFS_AVAILABLE,
6234};
6235
6236/**
6237 * enum nl80211_protocol_features - nl80211 protocol features
6238 * @NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP: nl80211 supports splitting
6239 *	wiphy dumps (if requested by the application with the attribute
6240 *	%NL80211_ATTR_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP. Also supported is filtering the
6241 *	wiphy dump by %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY, %NL80211_ATTR_IFINDEX or
6242 *	%NL80211_ATTR_WDEV.
6243 */
6244enum nl80211_protocol_features {
6245	NL80211_PROTOCOL_FEATURE_SPLIT_WIPHY_DUMP =	1 << 0,
6246};
6247
6248/**
6249 * enum nl80211_crit_proto_id - nl80211 critical protocol identifiers
6250 *
6251 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC: protocol unspecified.
6252 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP: BOOTP or DHCPv6 protocol.
6253 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL: EAPOL protocol.
6254 * @NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA: APIPA protocol.
6255 * @NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO: must be kept last.
6256 */
6257enum nl80211_crit_proto_id {
6258	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_UNSPEC,
6259	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_DHCP,
6260	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_EAPOL,
6261	NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_APIPA,
6262	/* add other protocols before this one */
6263	NUM_NL80211_CRIT_PROTO
6264};
6265
6266/* maximum duration for critical protocol measures */
6267#define NL80211_CRIT_PROTO_MAX_DURATION		5000 /* msec */
6268
6269/**
6270 * enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags - flags for received management frame.
6271 *
6272 * Used by cfg80211_rx_mgmt()
6273 *
6274 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED: frame was answered by device/driver.
6275 * @NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH: Host driver intends to offload
6276 *	the authentication. Exclusively defined for host drivers that
6277 *	advertises the SME functionality but would like the userspace
6278 *	to handle certain authentication algorithms (e.g. SAE).
6279 */
6280enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags {
6281	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_ANSWERED = 1 << 0,
6282	NL80211_RXMGMT_FLAG_EXTERNAL_AUTH = 1 << 1,
6283};
6284
6285/*
6286 * If this flag is unset, the lower 24 bits are an OUI, if set
6287 * a Linux nl80211 vendor ID is used (no such IDs are allocated
6288 * yet, so that's not valid so far)
6289 */
6290#define NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX	0x80000000
6291
6292/**
6293 * struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info - vendor command data
6294 * @vendor_id: If the %NL80211_VENDOR_ID_IS_LINUX flag is clear, then the
6295 *	value is a 24-bit OUI; if it is set then a separately allocated ID
6296 *	may be used, but no such IDs are allocated yet. New IDs should be
6297 *	added to this file when needed.
6298 * @subcmd: sub-command ID for the command
6299 */
6300struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info {
6301	__u32 vendor_id;
6302	__u32 subcmd;
6303};
6304
6305/**
6306 * enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability - TDLS peer flags.
6307 *
6308 * Used by tdls_mgmt() to determine which conditional elements need
6309 * to be added to TDLS Setup frames.
6310 *
6311 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT: TDLS peer is HT capable.
6312 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT: TDLS peer is VHT capable.
6313 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM: TDLS peer is WMM capable.
6314 * @NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE: TDLS peer is HE capable.
6315 */
6316enum nl80211_tdls_peer_capability {
6317	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HT = 1<<0,
6318	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_VHT = 1<<1,
6319	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_WMM = 1<<2,
6320	NL80211_TDLS_PEER_HE = 1<<3,
6321};
6322
6323/**
6324 * enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan - scanning plan for scheduled scan
6325 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6326 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL: interval between scan iterations. In
6327 *	seconds (u32).
6328 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS: number of scan iterations in this
6329 *	scan plan (u32). The last scan plan must not specify this attribute
6330 *	because it will run infinitely. A value of zero is invalid as it will
6331 *	make the scan plan meaningless.
6332 * @NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX: highest scheduled scan plan attribute number
6333 *	currently defined
6334 * @__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST: internal use
6335 */
6336enum nl80211_sched_scan_plan {
6337	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INVALID,
6338	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_INTERVAL,
6339	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_ITERATIONS,
6340
6341	/* keep last */
6342	__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST,
6343	NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_MAX =
6344		__NL80211_SCHED_SCAN_PLAN_AFTER_LAST - 1
6345};
6346
6347/**
6348 * struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust - RSSI adjustment parameters.
6349 *
6350 * @band: band of BSS that must match for RSSI value adjustment. The value
6351 *	of this field is according to &enum nl80211_band.
6352 * @delta: value used to adjust the RSSI value of matching BSS in dB.
6353 */
6354struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust {
6355	__u8 band;
6356	__s8 delta;
6357} __attribute__((packed));
6358
6359/**
6360 * enum nl80211_bss_select_attr - attributes for bss selection.
6361 *
6362 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID: reserved.
6363 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI: Flag indicating only RSSI-based BSS selection
6364 *	is requested.
6365 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF: attribute indicating BSS
6366 *	selection should be done such that the specified band is preferred.
6367 *	When there are multiple BSS-es in the preferred band, the driver
6368 *	shall use RSSI-based BSS selection as a second step. The value of
6369 *	this attribute is according to &enum nl80211_band (u32).
6370 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST: When present the RSSI level for
6371 *	BSS-es in the specified band is to be adjusted before doing
6372 *	RSSI-based BSS selection. The attribute value is a packed structure
6373 *	value as specified by &struct nl80211_bss_select_rssi_adjust.
6374 * @NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX: highest bss select attribute number.
6375 * @__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: internal use.
6376 *
6377 * One and only one of these attributes are found within %NL80211_ATTR_BSS_SELECT
6378 * for %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT. It specifies the required BSS selection behaviour
6379 * which the driver shall use.
6380 */
6381enum nl80211_bss_select_attr {
6382	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_INVALID,
6383	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI,
6384	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF,
6385	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST,
6386
6387	/* keep last */
6388	__NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST,
6389	NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_AFTER_LAST - 1
6390};
6391
6392/**
6393 * enum nl80211_nan_function_type - NAN function type
6394 *
6395 * Defines the function type of a NAN function
6396 *
6397 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH: function is publish
6398 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE: function is subscribe
6399 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP: function is follow-up
6400 */
6401enum nl80211_nan_function_type {
6402	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH,
6403	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE,
6404	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP,
6405
6406	/* keep last */
6407	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST,
6408	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_MAX_TYPE = __NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE_AFTER_LAST - 1,
6409};
6410
6411/**
6412 * enum nl80211_nan_publish_type - NAN publish tx type
6413 *
6414 * Defines how to send publish Service Discovery Frames
6415 *
6416 * @NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is solicited
6417 * @NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH: publish function is unsolicited
6418 */
6419enum nl80211_nan_publish_type {
6420	NL80211_NAN_SOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 0,
6421	NL80211_NAN_UNSOLICITED_PUBLISH = 1 << 1,
6422};
6423
6424/**
6425 * enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason - NAN functions termination reason
6426 *
6427 * Defines termination reasons of a NAN function
6428 *
6429 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST: requested by user
6430 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED: timeout
6431 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR: errored
6432 */
6433enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason {
6434	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST,
6435	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_TTL_EXPIRED,
6436	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_ERROR,
6437};
6438
6439#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN 6
6440#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_SPEC_INFO_MAX_LEN 0xff
6441#define NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF_MAX_LEN 0xff
6442
6443/**
6444 * enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes - NAN function attributes
6445 * @__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID: invalid
6446 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type (u8).
6447 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID: 6 bytes of the service ID hash as
6448 *	specified in NAN spec. This is a binary attribute.
6449 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE: relevant if the function's type is
6450 *	publish. Defines the transmission type for the publish Service Discovery
6451 *	Frame, see &enum nl80211_nan_publish_type. Its type is u8.
6452 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST: relevant if the function is a solicited
6453 *	publish. Should the solicited publish Service Discovery Frame be sent to
6454 *	the NAN Broadcast address. This is a flag.
6455 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE: relevant if the function's type is
6456 *	subscribe. Is the subscribe active. This is a flag.
6457 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID: relevant if the function's type is follow up.
6458 *	The instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is u8.
6459 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID: relevant if the function's type
6460 *	is follow up. This is a u8.
6461 *	The requestor instance ID for the follow up Service Discovery Frame.
6462 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST: the MAC address of the recipient of the
6463 *	follow up Service Discovery Frame. This is a binary attribute.
6464 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE: is this function limited for devices in a
6465 *	close range. The range itself (RSSI) is defined by the device.
6466 *	This is a flag.
6467 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL: strictly positive number of DWs this function should
6468 *	stay active. If not present infinite TTL is assumed. This is a u32.
6469 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO: array of bytes describing the service
6470 *	specific info. This is a binary attribute.
6471 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF: Service Receive Filter. This is a nested attribute.
6472 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes.
6473 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER: Receive Matching filter. This is a nested
6474 *	attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6475 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER: Transmit Matching filter. This is a
6476 *	nested attribute. It is a list of binary values.
6477 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID: The instance ID of the function.
6478 *	Its type is u8 and it cannot be 0.
6479 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON: NAN function termination reason.
6480 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason.
6481 *
6482 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR: internal
6483 * @NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN function attribute
6484 */
6485enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes {
6486	__NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INVALID,
6487	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TYPE,
6488	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID,
6489	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_TYPE,
6490	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH_BCAST,
6491	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE_ACTIVE,
6492	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_ID,
6493	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_REQ_ID,
6494	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP_DEST,
6495	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_CLOSE_RANGE,
6496	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TTL,
6497	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_INFO,
6498	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SRF,
6499	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_RX_MATCH_FILTER,
6500	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TX_MATCH_FILTER,
6501	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_INSTANCE_ID,
6502	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON,
6503
6504	/* keep last */
6505	NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR,
6506	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_FUNC_ATTR - 1
6507};
6508
6509/**
6510 * enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes - NAN Service Response filter attributes
6511 * @__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID: invalid
6512 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE: present if the include bit of the SRF set.
6513 *	This is a flag.
6514 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF: Bloom Filter. Present if and only if
6515 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS isn't present. This attribute is binary.
6516 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX: index of the Bloom Filter. Mandatory if
6517 *	%NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF is present. This is a u8.
6518 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS: list of MAC addresses for the SRF. Present if
6519 *	and only if %NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF isn't present. This is a nested
6520 *	attribute. Each nested attribute is a MAC address.
6521 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR: internal
6522 * @NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN SRF attribute
6523 */
6524enum nl80211_nan_srf_attributes {
6525	__NL80211_NAN_SRF_INVALID,
6526	NL80211_NAN_SRF_INCLUDE,
6527	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF,
6528	NL80211_NAN_SRF_BF_IDX,
6529	NL80211_NAN_SRF_MAC_ADDRS,
6530
6531	/* keep last */
6532	NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR,
6533	NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_SRF_ATTR - 1,
6534};
6535
6536/**
6537 * enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes - NAN match attributes
6538 * @__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID: invalid
6539 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL: the local function that had the
6540 *	match. This is a nested attribute.
6541 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6542 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER: the peer function
6543 *	that caused the match. This is a nested attribute.
6544 *	See &enum nl80211_nan_func_attributes.
6545 *
6546 * @NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR: internal
6547 * @NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX: highest NAN match attribute
6548 */
6549enum nl80211_nan_match_attributes {
6550	__NL80211_NAN_MATCH_INVALID,
6551	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_LOCAL,
6552	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_FUNC_PEER,
6553
6554	/* keep last */
6555	NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR,
6556	NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_NAN_MATCH_ATTR - 1
6557};
6558
6559/**
6560 * nl80211_external_auth_action - Action to perform with external
6561 *     authentication request. Used by NL80211_ATTR_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ACTION.
6562 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START: Start the authentication.
6563 * @NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT: Abort the ongoing authentication.
6564 */
6565enum nl80211_external_auth_action {
6566	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_START,
6567	NL80211_EXTERNAL_AUTH_ABORT,
6568};
6569
6570/**
6571 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes - fine timing measurement
6572 *	responder attributes
6573 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
6574 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED: FTM responder is enabled
6575 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: The content of Measurement Report Element
6576 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 8 - LCI (9.4.2.22.10),
6577 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6578 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVIC: The content of Measurement Report Element
6579 *	(9.4.2.22 in 802.11-2016) with type 11 - Civic (Section 9.4.2.22.13),
6580 *	i.e. starting with the measurement token
6581 * @__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
6582 * @NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest FTM responder attribute.
6583 */
6584enum nl80211_ftm_responder_attributes {
6585	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6586
6587	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_ENABLED,
6588	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
6589	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
6590
6591	/* keep last */
6592	__NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
6593	NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1,
6594};
6595
6596/*
6597 * enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
6598 *
6599 * These attribute types are used with %NL80211_ATTR_FTM_RESPONDER_STATS
6600 * when getting FTM responder statistics.
6601 *
6602 * @__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID: attribute number 0 is reserved
6603 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which all frames
6604 *	were ssfully answered (u32)
6605 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM: number of FTM sessions in which part of the
6606 *	frames were successfully answered (u32)
6607 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM: number of failed FTM sessions (u32)
6608 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM: number of ASAP sessions (u32)
6609 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM: number of non-ASAP sessions (u32)
6610 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC: total sessions durations - gives an
6611 *	indication of how much time the responder was busy (u64, msec)
6612 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of unknown FTM triggers -
6613 *	triggers from initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation
6614 *	phase with the responder (u32)
6615 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM: number of FTM reschedule requests
6616 *	- initiator asks for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled
6617 *	FTM slot (u32)
6618 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM: number of FTM triggers out of
6619 *	scheduled window (u32)
6620 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD: used for padding, ignore
6621 * @__NL80211_TXQ_ATTR_AFTER_LAST: Internal
6622 * @NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX: highest possible FTM responder stats attribute
6623 */
6624enum nl80211_ftm_responder_stats {
6625	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_INVALID,
6626	NL80211_FTM_STATS_SUCCESS_NUM,
6627	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PARTIAL_NUM,
6628	NL80211_FTM_STATS_FAILED_NUM,
6629	NL80211_FTM_STATS_ASAP_NUM,
6630	NL80211_FTM_STATS_NON_ASAP_NUM,
6631	NL80211_FTM_STATS_TOTAL_DURATION_MSEC,
6632	NL80211_FTM_STATS_UNKNOWN_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6633	NL80211_FTM_STATS_RESCHEDULE_REQUESTS_NUM,
6634	NL80211_FTM_STATS_OUT_OF_WINDOW_TRIGGERS_NUM,
6635	NL80211_FTM_STATS_PAD,
6636
6637	/* keep last */
6638	__NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST,
6639	NL80211_FTM_STATS_MAX = __NL80211_FTM_STATS_AFTER_LAST - 1
6640};
6641
6642/**
6643 * enum nl80211_preamble - frame preamble types
6644 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY: legacy (HR/DSSS, OFDM, ERP PHY) preamble
6645 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT: HT preamble
6646 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT: VHT preamble
6647 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG: DMG preamble
6648 * @NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE: HE preamble
6649 */
6650enum nl80211_preamble {
6651	NL80211_PREAMBLE_LEGACY,
6652	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HT,
6653	NL80211_PREAMBLE_VHT,
6654	NL80211_PREAMBLE_DMG,
6655	NL80211_PREAMBLE_HE,
6656};
6657
6658/**
6659 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type - peer measurement types
6660 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID: invalid/unused, needed as we use
6661 *	these numbers also for attributes
6662 *
6663 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM: flight time measurement
6664 *
6665 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES: internal
6666 * @NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX: highest type number
6667 */
6668enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type {
6669	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_INVALID,
6670
6671	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_FTM,
6672
6673	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES,
6674	NL80211_PMSR_TYPE_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_TYPES - 1
6675};
6676
6677/**
6678 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status - peer measurement status
6679 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS: measurement completed successfully
6680 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED: measurement was locally refused
6681 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT: measurement timed out
6682 * @NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE: measurement failed, a type-dependent
6683 *	reason may be available in the response data
6684 */
6685enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status {
6686	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_SUCCESS,
6687	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_REFUSED,
6688	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_TIMEOUT,
6689	NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE,
6690};
6691
6692/**
6693 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req - peer measurement request attributes
6694 * @__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6695 *
6696 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6697 *	type-specific request data inside. The attributes used are from the
6698 *	enums named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_req.
6699 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF: include AP TSF timestamp, if supported
6700 *	(flag attribute)
6701 *
6702 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS: internal
6703 * @NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6704 */
6705enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req {
6706	__NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6707
6708	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_DATA,
6709	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_GET_AP_TSF,
6710
6711	/* keep last */
6712	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS,
6713	NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_REQ_ATTRS - 1
6714};
6715
6716/**
6717 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp - peer measurement response attributes
6718 * @__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6719 *
6720 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA: This is a nested attribute with measurement
6721 *	type-specific results inside. The attributes used are from the enums
6722 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_resp.
6723 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS: u32 value with the measurement status
6724 *	(using values from &enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status.)
6725 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME: host time (%CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the
6726 *	result was measured; this value is not expected to be accurate to
6727 *	more than 20ms. (u64, nanoseconds)
6728 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF: TSF of the AP that the interface
6729 *	doing the measurement is connected to when the result was measured.
6730 *	This shall be accurately reported if supported and requested
6731 *	(u64, usec)
6732 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL: If results are sent to the host partially
6733 *	(*e.g. with FTM per-burst data) this flag will be cleared on all but
6734 *	the last result; if all results are combined it's set on the single
6735 *	result.
6736 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD: padding for 64-bit attributes, ignore
6737 *
6738 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS: internal
6739 * @NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6740 */
6741enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp {
6742	__NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
6743
6744	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_DATA,
6745	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_STATUS,
6746	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_HOST_TIME,
6747	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_AP_TSF,
6748	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_FINAL,
6749	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
6750
6751	/* keep last */
6752	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS,
6753	NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_RESP_ATTRS - 1
6754};
6755
6756/**
6757 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs - peer attributes for measurement
6758 * @__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6759 *
6760 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR: peer's MAC address
6761 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN: channel definition, nested, using top-level
6762 *	attributes like %NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_FREQ etc.
6763 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6764 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6765 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_req inside.
6766 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP: This is a nested attribute indexed by
6767 *	measurement type, with attributes from the
6768 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_resp inside.
6769 *
6770 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS: internal
6771 * @NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6772 */
6773enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs {
6774	__NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_INVALID,
6775
6776	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_ADDR,
6777	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_CHAN,
6778	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_REQ,
6779	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_RESP,
6780
6781	/* keep last */
6782	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS,
6783	NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_PEER_ATTRS - 1,
6784};
6785
6786/**
6787 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs - peer measurement attributes
6788 * @__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6789 *
6790 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS: u32 attribute used for capability
6791 *	advertisement only, indicates the maximum number of peers
6792 *	measurements can be done with in a single request
6793 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF: flag attribute in capability
6794 *	indicating that the connected AP's TSF can be reported in
6795 *	measurement results
6796 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR: flag attribute in capability
6797 *	indicating that MAC address randomization is supported.
6798 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA: capabilities reported by the device,
6799 *	this contains a nesting indexed by measurement type, and
6800 *	type-specific capabilities inside, which are from the enums
6801 *	named nl80211_peer_measurement_<type>_capa.
6802 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS: nested attribute, the nesting index is
6803 *	meaningless, just a list of peers to measure with, with the
6804 *	sub-attributes taken from
6805 *	&enum nl80211_peer_measurement_peer_attrs.
6806 *
6807 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR: internal
6808 * @NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6809 */
6810enum nl80211_peer_measurement_attrs {
6811	__NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_INVALID,
6812
6813	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX_PEERS,
6814	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_REPORT_AP_TSF,
6815	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_RANDOMIZE_MAC_ADDR,
6816	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_TYPE_CAPA,
6817	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_PEERS,
6818
6819	/* keep last */
6820	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR,
6821	NL80211_PMSR_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_ATTR - 1
6822};
6823
6824/**
6825 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa - FTM capabilities
6826 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6827 *
6828 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP: flag attribute indicating ASAP mode
6829 *	is supported
6830 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP: flag attribute indicating non-ASAP
6831 *	mode is supported
6832 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI: flag attribute indicating if LCI
6833 *	data can be requested during the measurement
6834 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC: flag attribute indicating if civic
6835 *	location data can be requested during the measurement
6836 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES: u32 bitmap attribute of bits
6837 *	from &enum nl80211_preamble.
6838 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS: bitmap of values from
6839 *	&enum nl80211_chan_width indicating the supported channel
6840 *	bandwidths for FTM. Note that a higher channel bandwidth may be
6841 *	configured to allow for other measurements types with different
6842 *	bandwidth requirement in the same measurement.
6843 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT: u32 attribute indicating
6844 *	the maximum bursts exponent that can be used (if not present anything
6845 *	is valid)
6846 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST: u32 attribute indicating
6847 *	the maximum FTMs per burst (if not present anything is valid)
6848 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating if
6849 *	trigger based ranging measurement is supported
6850 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: flag attribute indicating
6851 *	if non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
6852 *
6853 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR: internal
6854 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6855 */
6856enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_capa {
6857	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_INVALID,
6858
6859	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_ASAP,
6860	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_ASAP,
6861	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_LCI,
6862	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_REQ_CIVICLOC,
6863	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_PREAMBLES,
6864	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_BANDWIDTHS,
6865	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_BURSTS_EXPONENT,
6866	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6867	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
6868	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
6869
6870	/* keep last */
6871	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR,
6872	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_CAPA_ATTR - 1
6873};
6874
6875/**
6876 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req - FTM request attributes
6877 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6878 *
6879 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP: ASAP mode requested (flag)
6880 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE: preamble type (see
6881 *	&enum nl80211_preamble), optional for DMG (u32)
6882 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: number of bursts exponent as in
6883 *	802.11-2016 9.4.2.168 "Fine Timing Measurement Parameters element"
6884 *	(u8, 0-15, optional with default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6885 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD: interval between bursts in units
6886 *	of 100ms (u16, optional with default 0)
6887 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: burst duration, as in 802.11-2016
6888 *	Table 9-257 "Burst Duration field encoding" (u8, 0-15, optional with
6889 *	default 15 i.e. "no preference")
6890 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: number of successful FTM frames
6891 *	requested per burst
6892 *	(u8, 0-31, optional with default 0 i.e. "no preference")
6893 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES: number of FTMR frame retries
6894 *	(u8, default 3)
6895 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI: request LCI data (flag)
6896 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC: request civic location data
6897 *	(flag)
6898 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED: request trigger based ranging
6899 *	measurement (flag).
6900 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED are
6901 *	mutually exclusive.
6902 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
6903 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
6904 *	ranging will be used.
6905 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED: request non trigger based
6906 *	ranging measurement (flag)
6907 *	This attribute and %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED are
6908 *	mutually exclusive.
6909 *      if neither %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED nor
6910 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set, EDCA based
6911 *	ranging will be used.
6912 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK: negotiate for LMR feedback. Only
6913 *	valid if either %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED or
6914 *	%NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED is set.
6915 *
6916 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR: internal
6917 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
6918 */
6919enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_req {
6920	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_INVALID,
6921
6922	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_ASAP,
6923	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_PREAMBLE,
6924	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
6925	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_PERIOD,
6926	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
6927	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
6928	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_RETRIES,
6929	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_LCI,
6930	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_REQUEST_CIVICLOC,
6931	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_TRIGGER_BASED,
6932	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_NON_TRIGGER_BASED,
6933	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_LMR_FEEDBACK,
6934
6935	/* keep last */
6936	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR,
6937	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_REQ_ATTR - 1
6938};
6939
6940/**
6941 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons - FTM failure reasons
6942 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED: unspecified failure, not used
6943 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE: no response from the FTM responder
6944 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED: FTM responder rejected measurement
6945 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL: we already know the peer is
6946 *	on a different channel, so can't measure (if we didn't know, we'd
6947 *	try and get no response)
6948 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE: peer can't actually do FTM
6949 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP: invalid T1/T4 timestamps
6950 *	received
6951 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY: peer reports busy, you may retry
6952 *	later (see %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME)
6953 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS: parameters were changed
6954 *	by the peer and are no longer supported
6955 */
6956enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons {
6957	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_UNSPECIFIED,
6958	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_NO_RESPONSE,
6959	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_REJECTED,
6960	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_WRONG_CHANNEL,
6961	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_NOT_CAPABLE,
6962	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_INVALID_TIMESTAMP,
6963	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
6964	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_BAD_CHANGED_PARAMS,
6965};
6966
6967/**
6968 * enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp - FTM response attributes
6969 * @__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: invalid
6970 *
6971 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON: FTM-specific failure reason
6972 *	(u32, optional)
6973 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX: optional, if bursts are reported
6974 *	as separate results then it will be the burst index 0...(N-1) and
6975 *	the top level will indicate partial results (u32)
6976 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS: number of FTM Request frames
6977 *	transmitted (u32, optional)
6978 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES: number of FTM Request frames
6979 *	that were acknowleged (u32, optional)
6980 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME: retry time received from the
6981 *	busy peer (u32, seconds)
6982 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP: actual number of bursts exponent
6983 *	used by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6984 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION: actual burst duration used by
6985 *	the responder (similar to request, u8)
6986 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST: actual FTMs per burst used
6987 *	by the responder (similar to request, u8)
6988 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG: average RSSI across all FTM action
6989 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6990 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD: RSSI spread across all FTM action
6991 *	frames (optional, s32, 1/2 dBm)
6992 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE: bitrate we used for the response to the
6993 *	FTM action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info
6994 *	attributes)
6995 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE: bitrate the responder used for the FTM
6996 *	action frame (optional, nested, using &enum nl80211_rate_info attrs)
6997 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG: average RTT (s64, picoseconds, optional
6998 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
6999 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE: RTT variance (u64, ps^2, note that
7000 *	standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7001 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD: RTT spread (u64, picoseconds,
7002 *	optional)
7003 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG: average distance (s64, mm, optional
7004 *	but one of RTT/DIST must be present)
7005 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE: distance variance (u64, mm^2, note
7006 *	that standard deviation is the square root of variance, optional)
7007 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD: distance spread (u64, mm, optional)
7008 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI: LCI data from peer (binary, optional);
7009 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7010 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7011 *	Type 8.
7012 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC: civic location data from peer
7013 *	(binary, optional);
7014 *	this is the contents of the Measurement Report Element (802.11-2016
7015 *	9.4.2.22.1) starting with the Measurement Token, with Measurement
7016 *	Type 11.
7017 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD: ignore, for u64/s64 padding only
7018 *
7019 * @NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR: internal
7020 * @NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute number
7021 */
7022enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_resp {
7023	__NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7024
7025	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FAIL_REASON,
7026	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_INDEX,
7027	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_ATTEMPTS,
7028	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_FTMR_SUCCESSES,
7029	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BUSY_RETRY_TIME,
7030	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_NUM_BURSTS_EXP,
7031	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_BURST_DURATION,
7032	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_FTMS_PER_BURST,
7033	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_AVG,
7034	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RSSI_SPREAD,
7035	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_TX_RATE,
7036	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RX_RATE,
7037	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_AVG,
7038	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_VARIANCE,
7039	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_RTT_SPREAD,
7040	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_AVG,
7041	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_VARIANCE,
7042	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_DIST_SPREAD,
7043	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_LCI,
7044	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_CIVICLOC,
7045	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_PAD,
7046
7047	/* keep last */
7048	NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR,
7049	NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR_MAX = NUM_NL80211_PMSR_FTM_RESP_ATTR - 1
7050};
7051
7052/**
7053 * enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes - OBSS packet detection attributes
7054 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7055 *
7056 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET: the OBSS PD minimum tx power offset.
7057 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET: the OBSS PD maximum tx power offset.
7058 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET: the non-SRG OBSS PD maximum
7059 *	tx power offset.
7060 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the BSS color
7061 *	values used by members of the SRG.
7062 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP: bitmap that indicates the partial
7063 *	BSSID values used by members of the SRG.
7064 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL: The SR Control field of SRP element.
7065 *
7066 * @__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7067 * @NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX: highest OBSS PD attribute.
7068 */
7069enum nl80211_obss_pd_attributes {
7070	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_INVALID,
7071
7072	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MIN_OFFSET,
7073	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX_OFFSET,
7074	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_NON_SRG_MAX_OFFSET,
7075	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_BSS_COLOR_BITMAP,
7076	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_PARTIAL_BSSID_BITMAP,
7077	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_SR_CTRL,
7078
7079	/* keep last */
7080	__NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST,
7081	NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_OBSS_PD_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7082};
7083
7084/**
7085 * enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes - BSS Color attributes
7086 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7087 *
7088 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR: the current BSS Color.
7089 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED: is BSS coloring disabled.
7090 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL: the AID equation to be used..
7091 *
7092 * @__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7093 * @NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX: highest BSS Color attribute.
7094 */
7095enum nl80211_bss_color_attributes {
7096	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_INVALID,
7097
7098	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_COLOR,
7099	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_DISABLED,
7100	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_PARTIAL,
7101
7102	/* keep last */
7103	__NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST,
7104	NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_HE_BSS_COLOR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7105};
7106
7107/**
7108 * enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes - interface type AKM attributes
7109 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7110 *
7111 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES: nested attribute containing a flag
7112 *	attribute for each interface type that supports AKM suites specified in
7113 *	%NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES
7114 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES: an array of u32. Used to indicate supported
7115 *	AKM suites for the specified interface types.
7116 *
7117 * @__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7118 * @NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX: highest interface type AKM attribute.
7119 */
7120enum nl80211_iftype_akm_attributes {
7121	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_INVALID,
7122
7123	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_IFTYPES,
7124	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_SUITES,
7125
7126	/* keep last */
7127	__NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST,
7128	NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_IFTYPE_AKM_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7129};
7130
7131/**
7132 * enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes - FILS discovery configuration
7133 * from IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
7134 *
7135 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7136 *
7137 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN: Minimum packet interval (u32, TU).
7138 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7139 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7140 *	Allowed range: 0..10000 (TU = Time Unit)
7141 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL: Template data for FILS discovery action
7142 *	frame including the headers.
7143 *
7144 * @__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7145 * @NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7146 */
7147enum nl80211_fils_discovery_attributes {
7148	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INVALID,
7149
7150	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MIN,
7151	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_INT_MAX,
7152	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_TMPL,
7153
7154	/* keep last */
7155	__NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST,
7156	NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_ATTR_LAST - 1
7157};
7158
7159/*
7160 * FILS discovery template minimum length with action frame headers and
7161 * mandatory fields.
7162 */
7163#define NL80211_FILS_DISCOVERY_TMPL_MIN_LEN 42
7164
7165/**
7166 * enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes - Unsolicited broadcast probe
7167 *	response configuration. Applicable only in 6GHz.
7168 *
7169 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID: Invalid
7170 *
7171 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT: Maximum packet interval (u32, TU).
7172 *	Allowed range: 0..20 (TU = Time Unit). IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0
7173 *	26.17.2.3.2 (AP behavior for fast passive scanning).
7174 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
7175 *	frame template (binary).
7176 *
7177 * @__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7178 * @NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX: highest attribute
7179 */
7180enum nl80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_attributes {
7181	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INVALID,
7182
7183	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_INT,
7184	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_TMPL,
7185
7186	/* keep last */
7187	__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST,
7188	NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_MAX =
7189		__NL80211_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP_ATTR_LAST - 1
7190};
7191
7192/**
7193 * enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism - The mechanism(s) allowed for SAE PWE
7194 *	derivation. Applicable only when WPA3-Personal SAE authentication is
7195 *	used.
7196 *
7197 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED: not specified, used internally to indicate that
7198 *	attribute is not present from userspace.
7199 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK: hunting-and-pecking loop only
7200 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT: hash-to-element only
7201 * @NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH: both hunting-and-pecking loop and hash-to-element
7202 *	can be used.
7203 */
7204enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism {
7205	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED,
7206	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK,
7207	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT,
7208	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH,
7209};
7210
7211/**
7212 * enum nl80211_sar_type - type of SAR specs
7213 *
7214 * @NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER: power limitation specified in 0.25dBm unit
7215 *
7216 */
7217enum nl80211_sar_type {
7218	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER,
7219
7220	/* add new type here */
7221
7222	/* Keep last */
7223	NUM_NL80211_SAR_TYPE,
7224};
7225
7226/**
7227 * enum nl80211_sar_attrs - Attributes for SAR spec
7228 *
7229 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE: the SAR type as defined in &enum nl80211_sar_type.
7230 *
7231 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS: Nested array of SAR power
7232 *	limit specifications. Each specification contains a set
7233 *	of %nl80211_sar_specs_attrs.
7234 *
7235 *	For SET operation, it contains array of %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER
7236 *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX.
7237 *
7238 *	For sar_capa dump, it contains array of
7239 *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ
7240 *	and %NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ.
7241 *
7242 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST: Internal
7243 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX: highest sar attribute
7244 *
7245 * These attributes are used with %NL80211_CMD_SET_SAR_SPEC
7246 */
7247enum nl80211_sar_attrs {
7248	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_INVALID,
7249
7250	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_TYPE,
7251	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS,
7252
7253	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST,
7254	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_LAST - 1,
7255};
7256
7257/**
7258 * enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs - Attributes for SAR power limit specs
7259 *
7260 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER: Required (s32)value to specify the actual
7261 *	power limit value in units of 0.25 dBm if type is
7262 *	NL80211_SAR_TYPE_POWER. (i.e., a value of 44 represents 11 dBm).
7263 *	0 means userspace doesn't have SAR limitation on this associated range.
7264 *
7265 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX: Required (u32) value to specify the
7266 *	index of exported freq range table and the associated power limitation
7267 *	is applied to this range.
7268 *
7269 *	Userspace isn't required to set all the ranges advertised by WLAN driver,
7270 *	and userspace can skip some certain ranges. These skipped ranges don't
7271 *	have SAR limitations, and they are same as setting the
7272 *	%NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER to any unreasonable high value because any
7273 *	value higher than regulatory allowed value just means SAR power
7274 *	limitation is removed, but it's required to set at least one range.
7275 *	It's not allowed to set duplicated range in one SET operation.
7276 *
7277 *	Every SET operation overwrites previous SET operation.
7278 *
7279 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the start
7280 *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7281 *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7282 *
7283 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ: Required (u32) value to specify the end
7284 *	frequency of this range edge when registering SAR capability to wiphy.
7285 *	It's not a channel center frequency. The unit is kHz.
7286 *
7287 * @__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST: Internal
7288 * @NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX: highest sar specs attribute
7289 */
7290enum nl80211_sar_specs_attrs {
7291	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_INVALID,
7292
7293	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_POWER,
7294	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_RANGE_INDEX,
7295	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_START_FREQ,
7296	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_END_FREQ,
7297
7298	__NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST,
7299	NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_MAX = __NL80211_SAR_ATTR_SPECS_LAST - 1,
7300};
7301
7302#endif /* __LINUX_NL80211_H */
7303